services: Rename 'dmd' services to 'shepherd'.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
CommitLineData
568717fd
LC
1\input texinfo
2@c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4@c %**start of header
5@setfilename guix.info
6@documentencoding UTF-8
f8348b91 7@settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
568717fd
LC
8@c %**end of header
9
10@include version.texi
7df7a74e
NK
11
12@copying
db5a9444 13Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016 Ludovic Courtès@*
af8a56b8 14Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014 Andreas Enge@*
87eafdbd 15Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
8c01b9d0
ML
16Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Mathieu Lirzin@*
17Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
97d76250
LF
18Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
19Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Leo Famulari
7df7a74e
NK
20
21Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
22under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
23any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
24Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
25copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
26Documentation License''.
27@end copying
568717fd 28
eeaf4427 29@dircategory Package management
568717fd
LC
30@direntry
31* guix: (guix). Guix, the functional package manager.
e49951eb 32* guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package
eeaf4427 33 Managing packages with Guix.
e49951eb 34* guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build
568717fd 35 Building packages with Guix.
054e8576
LC
36* guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system
37 Managing the operating system configuration.
568717fd 38@end direntry
568717fd 39
372c4bbc
DT
40@dircategory Software development
41@direntry
42* guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment
43 Building development environments with Guix.
44@end direntry
45
568717fd 46@titlepage
7730d112
LC
47@title GNU Guix Reference Manual
48@subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
2cbed07e 49@author The GNU Guix Developers
568717fd
LC
50
51@page
52@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
53Edition @value{EDITION} @*
54@value{UPDATED} @*
55
7df7a74e 56@insertcopying
568717fd
LC
57@end titlepage
58
568717fd
LC
59@contents
60
61@c *********************************************************************
62@node Top
f8348b91 63@top GNU Guix
568717fd 64
f8348b91
LC
65This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
66package management tool written for the GNU system.
568717fd
LC
67
68@menu
69* Introduction:: What is Guix about?
bd5e766b 70* Installation:: Installing Guix.
eeaf4427 71* Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
c554de89 72* Emacs Interface:: Using Guix from Emacs.
568717fd
LC
73* Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
74* Utilities:: Package management commands.
a1ba8475 75* GNU Distribution:: Software for your friendly GNU system.
9bf3c1a7 76* Contributing:: Your help needed!
568717fd
LC
77
78* Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
79* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
80* Concept Index:: Concepts.
a85b83d2 81* Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
aaa3eaa9
LC
82
83@detailmenu
84 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
85
86Installation
87
1b2b8177 88* Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
aaa3eaa9 89* Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
ec0339cd 90* Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
aaa3eaa9
LC
91* Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
92* Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
0e2d0213 93* Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
aaa3eaa9
LC
94
95Setting Up the Daemon
96
97* Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
98* Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
99
100Package Management
101
102* Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
103* Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
aaa3eaa9
LC
104* Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
105* Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
106* Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
107* Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
108* Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
109
c554de89
AK
110Emacs Interface
111
112* Initial Setup: Emacs Initial Setup. Preparing @file{~/.emacs}.
113* Package Management: Emacs Package Management. Managing packages and generations.
687c9bc0 114* Licenses: Emacs Licenses. Interface for licenses of Guix packages.
9b0afb0d 115* Popup Interface: Emacs Popup Interface. Magit-like interface for guix commands.
c554de89 116* Prettify Mode: Emacs Prettify. Abbreviating @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}} file names.
34850cd5 117* Build Log Mode: Emacs Build Log. Highlighting Guix build logs.
187f80c6
AK
118* Completions: Emacs Completions. Completing @command{guix} shell command.
119* Development: Emacs Development. Tools for Guix developers.
32950fc8 120* Hydra: Emacs Hydra. Interface for Guix build farm.
c554de89 121
aaa3eaa9
LC
122Programming Interface
123
124* Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
125* Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
126* The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
127* Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
128* The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
129* G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
130
92492b23
LC
131Defining Packages
132
133* package Reference:: The package data type.
134* origin Reference:: The origin data type.
135
aaa3eaa9
LC
136Utilities
137
138* Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
fcc58db6 139* Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
aaa3eaa9
LC
140* Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
141* Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
142* Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
143* Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
144* Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
fcc58db6 145* Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
88856916 146* Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
aaa3eaa9 147* Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
aff8ce7c 148* Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
d23c20f1 149* Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
32efa254 150* Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
aaa3eaa9
LC
151
152GNU Distribution
153
154* System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
35ed9306 155* System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
aaa3eaa9
LC
156* Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
157* Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
158* Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
159* Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
160* Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
161* Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
162
163System Configuration
164
165* Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
166* operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
167* File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
168* Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
169* User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
598e19dc 170* Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
aaa3eaa9
LC
171* Services:: Specifying system services.
172* Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
1b2b8177 173* X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
996ed739 174* Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
aaa3eaa9
LC
175* Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
176* GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
177* Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
97d76250 178* Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
aaa3eaa9
LC
179* Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
180
181Services
182
183* Base Services:: Essential system services.
184* Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
185* X Window:: Graphical display.
1b2b8177
LC
186* Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
187* Database Services:: SQL databases.
d8c18af8 188* Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
cbd02397 189* Web Services:: Web servers.
aa4ed923 190* Various Services:: Other services.
aaa3eaa9 191
0adfe95a
LC
192Defining Services
193
194* Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
195* Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
196* Service Reference:: API reference.
dd17bc38 197* Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
0adfe95a 198
aaa3eaa9
LC
199Packaging Guidelines
200
ec0339cd
LC
201* Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
202* Package Naming:: What's in a name?
203* Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
cbd02397 204* Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
ec0339cd
LC
205* Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
206* Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
207* Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
aaa3eaa9 208
8c01b9d0
ML
209Contributing
210
211* Building from Git:: The latest and greatest.
212* Running Guix Before It Is Installed:: Hacker tricks.
213* The Perfect Setup:: The right tools.
214* Coding Style:: Hygiene of the contributor.
215* Submitting Patches:: Share your work.
216
217Coding Style
218
219* Programming Paradigm:: How to compose your elements.
220* Modules:: Where to store your code?
221* Data Types and Pattern Matching:: Implementing data structures.
222* Formatting Code:: Writing conventions.
223
aaa3eaa9 224@end detailmenu
568717fd
LC
225@end menu
226
227@c *********************************************************************
228@node Introduction
229@chapter Introduction
230
c80e7e55
LC
231GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
232using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a functional
233package management tool for the GNU system. Package management consists
4bfc4ea3
NK
234of all activities that relate to building packages from sources,
235honoring their build-time and run-time dependencies,
c80e7e55
LC
236installing packages in user environments, upgrading installed packages
237to new versions or rolling back to a previous set, removing unused
238software packages, etc.
568717fd
LC
239
240@cindex functional package management
241The term @dfn{functional} refers to a specific package management
136787cb
LC
242discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
243In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
4bfc4ea3
NK
244as a function, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
245such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
246returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
568717fd
LC
247solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
248scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
4bfc4ea3
NK
249always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
250cannot alter the system's environment in
568717fd
LC
251any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
252of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
e900c503 253build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
4bfc4ea3 254explicit inputs are visible.
568717fd 255
e531ac2a 256@cindex store
568717fd 257The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
e531ac2a
LC
258system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
259Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own, in the
834129e0 260store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
568717fd
LC
261a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
262input yields a different directory name.
263
264This approach is the foundation of Guix's salient features: support for
4bfc4ea3 265transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
eeaf4427 266garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
568717fd 267
4bfc4ea3 268Guix has a command-line interface, which allows users to build, install,
568717fd 269upgrade, and remove packages, as well as a Scheme programming interface.
568717fd 270
3ca2731c 271@cindex Guix System Distribution
4705641f 272@cindex GuixSD
a1ba8475 273Last but not least, Guix is used to build a distribution of the GNU
3ca2731c 274system, with many GNU and non-GNU free software packages. The Guix
4705641f
LC
275System Distribution, or GNU@tie{}GuixSD, takes advantage of the core
276properties of Guix at the system level. With GuixSD, users
3ca2731c
LC
277@emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system configuration, and
278Guix takes care of instantiating that configuration in a reproducible,
279stateless fashion. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
a1ba8475 280
bd5e766b
LC
281@c *********************************************************************
282@node Installation
283@chapter Installation
284
48febeb8
LC
285GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
286@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}. This section describes the
287software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it and get
288ready to use it.
bd5e766b 289
5af6de3e
LC
290Note that this section is concerned with the installation of the package
291manager, which can be done on top of a running GNU/Linux system. If,
292instead, you want to install the complete GNU operating system,
6621cdb6 293@pxref{System Installation}.
5af6de3e 294
bd5e766b 295@menu
09722b11 296* Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
bd5e766b 297* Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
ec0339cd 298* Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
bd5e766b
LC
299* Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
300* Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
0e2d0213 301* Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
bd5e766b
LC
302@end menu
303
09722b11
LC
304@node Binary Installation
305@section Binary Installation
306
307This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
308self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
309dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
310is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
311GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
312
313Installing goes along these lines:
314
315@enumerate
316@item
317Download the binary tarball from
daa8922a
LC
318@indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
319where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
320already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
321
322Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
323authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
324
325@example
326$ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
327$ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
328@end example
329
330If that command fails because you don't have the required public key,
331then run this command to import it:
332
333@example
334$ gpg --keyserver keys.gnupg.net --recv-keys 3D9AEBB5
335@end example
336
337@noindent
338and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
09722b11
LC
339
340@item
341As @code{root}, run:
342
343@example
5dc42964 344# cd /tmp
254b1c2e
LC
345# tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
346 guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
5dc42964 347# mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
09722b11
LC
348@end example
349
7acd3439
LC
350This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
351The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
352step.)
09722b11 353
5dc3ce5f
LC
354Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
355would overwrite its own essential files.
356
254b1c2e 357The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
e9ba6357
LC
358not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
359warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
360versions are fine.)
361They stem from the fact that all the
254b1c2e
LC
362files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
363means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
364archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
365reproducible.
366
7acd3439
LC
367@item
368Make @code{root}'s profile available under @file{~/.guix-profile}:
369
370@example
371# ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile \
372 ~root/.guix-profile
373@end example
374
43c33047
LC
375@item
376Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
377(@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
378
09722b11 379@item
175ced41 380Run the daemon:
09722b11
LC
381
382@example
7acd3439 383# ~root/.guix-profile/bin/guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
09722b11
LC
384@end example
385
d2825c96
LC
386On hosts using the systemd init system, drop
387@file{~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service} in
388@file{/etc/systemd/system}.
389
ad227484
MDRS
390Likewise, on hosts using the Upstart init system, drop
391@file{~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf} in
392@file{/etc/init}.
393
09722b11
LC
394@item
395Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
396for instance with:
397
398@example
399# mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
400# cd /usr/local/bin
d72d05f9 401# ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/bin/guix
09722b11 402@end example
39f8ed14 403
aca738f3
LC
404It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
405there:
406
407@example
408# mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
409# cd /usr/local/share/info
410# for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/share/info/* ;
411 do ln -s $i ; done
412@end example
413
414That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
415running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
416Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
417Info search path.)
418
39f8ed14
LC
419@item
420To use substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Substitutes}),
421authorize them:
422
423@example
7acd3439 424# guix archive --authorize < ~root/.guix-profile/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub
39f8ed14 425@end example
09722b11
LC
426@end enumerate
427
53de532f
LC
428And that's it! For additional tips and tricks, @pxref{Application
429Setup}.
09722b11 430
5dc3ce5f 431The @code{guix} package must remain available in @code{root}'s
09722b11
LC
432profile, or it would become subject to garbage collection---in which
433case you would find yourself badly handicapped by the lack of the
434@command{guix} command.
435
39f8ed14
LC
436The tarball in question can be (re)produced and verified simply by
437running the following command in the Guix source tree:
09722b11
LC
438
439@example
440make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
441@end example
442
443
bd5e766b
LC
444@node Requirements
445@section Requirements
446
09722b11
LC
447This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
448build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
449not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
450in the Guix source tree for additional details.
451
bd5e766b
LC
452GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
453
454@itemize
47c66da0 455@item @url{http://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.0.7 or later;
288dca55 456@item @url{http://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
f0b98b84 457@item @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
8a96bd4b
ID
458@end itemize
459
460The following dependencies are optional:
461
462@itemize
288dca55 463@item
8a96bd4b 464Installing
288dca55 465@url{http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} will
2f7d2d91
LC
466allow you to use the @command{guix import pypi} command (@pxref{Invoking
467guix import}). It is of
288dca55 468interest primarily for developers and not for casual users.
8a96bd4b
ID
469@item
470Installing @uref{http://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS-Guile} will
471allow you to access @code{https} URLs with the @command{guix download}
d45dc6da
EB
472command (@pxref{Invoking guix download}), the @command{guix import pypi}
473command, and the @command{guix import cpan} command. This is primarily
474of interest to developers. @xref{Guile Preparations, how to install the
475GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile}.
bd5e766b
LC
476@end itemize
477
478Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
479following packages are also needed:
480
481@itemize
368d08f7
LC
482@item @url{http://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
483@item @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2};
484@item @url{http://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
485C++11 standard.
bd5e766b
LC
486@end itemize
487
4bfc4ea3
NK
488When a working installation of @url{http://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
489manager} is available, you
bd5e766b 490can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
4bfc4ea3 491Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
bd5e766b 492
b22a12fd
LC
493Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
494between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
495same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
4bfc4ea3
NK
496@code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
497specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
834129e0 498located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
b22a12fd 499@code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
4bfc4ea3
NK
500Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
501your goal is to share the store with Nix.
b22a12fd 502
ec0339cd
LC
503@node Running the Test Suite
504@section Running the Test Suite
505
506After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
507idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
508environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
509failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
510suite, type:
511
512@example
513make check
514@end example
515
516Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
517GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
518on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
519that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
520cache.
521
a887fd8d
LC
522It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
523@code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
524
525@example
526make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
527@end example
528
ec0339cd
LC
529Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
530@file{test-suite.log} file. When @file{tests/@var{something}.scm}
531fails, please also attach the @file{@var{something}.log} file available
532in the top-level build directory. Please specify the Guix version being
533used as well as version numbers of the dependencies
534(@pxref{Requirements}) in your message.
535
bd5e766b
LC
536@node Setting Up the Daemon
537@section Setting Up the Daemon
538
539@cindex daemon
540Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
49e6291a 541are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
bd5e766b
LC
542behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
543associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
544goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
e49951eb 545@command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
bd5e766b
LC
546daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
547
49e6291a 548The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
225dafde
LC
549environment. Also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
550the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
49e6291a
LC
551
552@menu
553* Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
554* Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
555@end menu
556
557@node Build Environment Setup
558@subsection Build Environment Setup
559
bd5e766b
LC
560In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
561@command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
834129e0 562administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
bd5e766b
LC
563@command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
564Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
565daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
566consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
567
568@cindex build users
569When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
570build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
571security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
572should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
573These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
574just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
575processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
576distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
577do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
578regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
579
580On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
581Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
582
091196b3
LC
583@c See http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
584@c for why `-G' is needed.
bd5e766b 585@example
cfc149dc
LC
586# groupadd --system guixbuild
587# for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
bd5e766b 588 do
cfc149dc
LC
589 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
590 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
591 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
592 guixbuilder$i;
bd5e766b
LC
593 done
594@end example
595
596@noindent
54eb03ab
LC
597The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
598parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
d2825c96
LC
599(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). The
600@code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
601following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
602dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
603file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
ad227484
MDRS
604@command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
605machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
606@file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
607file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
bd5e766b
LC
608
609@example
cfc149dc 610# guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
bd5e766b
LC
611@end example
612
e900c503 613@cindex chroot
b095792f
LC
614@noindent
615This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
cfc149dc 616the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
6dc99317
LC
617environment contains nothing but:
618
619@c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
620@itemize
621@item
4743a4da
LC
622a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
623host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
624that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
625can only be created if the host has them.};
626
627@item
628the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the container's processes
629since a separate PID name space is used;
6dc99317
LC
630
631@item
632@file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
633user @file{nobody};
634
635@item
636@file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
637
638@item
639@file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
640@code{127.0.0.1};
641
642@item
643a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
644@end itemize
b095792f 645
cb960102
ED
646You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
647@i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
7a57c96a 648within the chroot is always @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
cb960102
ED
649where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
650This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
651environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
652capture the name of their build tree.
653
e0c941fe
LC
654@vindex http_proxy
655The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
656HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
657(@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
658
1e2644bb
LC
659If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
660to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
661However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
662from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
663each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
664available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
665@emph{pure} functions.
bd5e766b 666
49e6291a
LC
667
668@node Daemon Offload Setup
669@subsection Using the Offload Facility
670
671@cindex offloading
4ec2e92d
LC
672@cindex build hook
673When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload}
674derivation builds to other machines
49e6291a
LC
675running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build hook}. When that
676feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
677@file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; anytime a build is requested, for
678instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
679of the machines that satisfies the derivation's constraints, in
680particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
681prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
682which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
683build are copied back to the initial machine.
684
4ec2e92d 685The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
49e6291a
LC
686
687@example
688(list (build-machine
689 (name "eightysix.example.org")
690 (system "x86_64-linux")
691 (user "bob")
692 (speed 2.)) ; incredibly fast!
693
694 (build-machine
695 (name "meeps.example.org")
696 (system "mips64el-linux")
697 (user "alice")
698 (private-key
699 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
c4fdfd6f 700 "/.lsh/identity-for-guix"))))
49e6291a
LC
701@end example
702
703@noindent
704In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
705the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
4ec2e92d
LC
706architecture.
707
708In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
709evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
710must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
711shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
712DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
713local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
c678a4ee
LC
714Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
715detailed below.
4ec2e92d 716
c678a4ee
LC
717@deftp {Data Type} build-machine
718This data type represents build machines the daemon may offload builds
719to. The important fields are:
49e6291a
LC
720
721@table @code
722
723@item name
724The remote machine's host name.
725
726@item system
c678a4ee 727The remote machine's system type---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
49e6291a
LC
728
729@item user
730The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
731Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
732allow non-interactive logins.
733
734@end table
735
4ec2e92d 736A number of optional fields may be specified:
49e6291a
LC
737
738@table @code
739
cecd72d5
LC
740@item port
741Port number of the machine's SSH server (default: 22).
742
49e6291a
LC
743@item private-key
744The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine.
745
c4fdfd6f
LC
746Currently offloading uses GNU@tie{}lsh as its SSH client
747(@pxref{Invoking lsh,,, GNU lsh Manual}). Thus, the key file here must
748be an lsh key file. This may change in the future, though.
749
49e6291a
LC
750@item parallel-builds
751The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine (1 by
752default.)
753
754@item speed
755A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
756machines with a higher speed factor.
757
758@item features
759A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
760An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
761and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
762name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
763
764@end table
c678a4ee 765@end deftp
49e6291a
LC
766
767The @code{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
768machines, since offloading works by invoking the @code{guix archive} and
c4fdfd6f
LC
769@code{guix build} commands. In addition, the Guix modules must be in
770@code{$GUILE_LOAD_PATH} on the build machine---you can check whether
771this is the case by running:
772
773@example
74273b6f 774lsh build-machine guile -c "'(use-modules (guix config))'"
c4fdfd6f 775@end example
49e6291a
LC
776
777There's one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
778explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
c4fdfd6f
LC
779between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
780generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
781archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
49e6291a
LC
782
783@example
784# guix archive --generate-key
785@end example
786
787@noindent
c4fdfd6f
LC
788Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
789it accepts store items it receives from the master:
790
791@example
792# guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
793@end example
794
795@noindent
796Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
797
798All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
799relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
800the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
801build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
802with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
49e6291a
LC
803
804
bd5e766b
LC
805@node Invoking guix-daemon
806@section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
807
808The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
809access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
810garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
811is normally run as @code{root} like this:
812
813@example
cfc149dc 814# guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
bd5e766b
LC
815@end example
816
817@noindent
081145cf 818For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
bd5e766b 819
e900c503
LC
820@cindex chroot
821@cindex container, build environment
822@cindex build environment
823@cindex reproducible builds
bd5e766b
LC
824By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
825different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
826@code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
827chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
828build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
829(@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
830system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
e900c503
LC
831@file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
832@dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
833a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
834etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
bd5e766b 835
cbc538fe
LC
836When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
837build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
838its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable; this directory is shared with
839the container for the duration of the build. Be aware that using a
840directory other than @file{/tmp} can affect build results---for example,
841with a longer directory name, a build process that uses Unix-domain
842sockets might hit the name length limitation for @code{sun_path}, which
843it would otherwise not hit.
844
845The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
846build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
847(@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
848
bd5e766b
LC
849The following command-line options are supported:
850
851@table @code
852@item --build-users-group=@var{group}
853Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
854the Daemon, build users}).
855
6858f9d1 856@item --no-substitutes
b5385b52 857@cindex substitutes
6858f9d1 858Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
c4202d60
LC
859locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
860(@pxref{Substitutes}).
6858f9d1 861
b5385b52
LC
862By default substitutes are used, unless the client---such as the
863@command{guix package} command---is explicitly invoked with
864@code{--no-substitutes}.
865
866When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
867explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
868remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
869
9176607e 870@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
f8a8e0fe 871@anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
9176607e 872Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
ae806096 873source URLs. When this option is omitted, @indicateurl{http://hydra.gnu.org}
9176607e
LC
874is used.
875
876This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
877as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
878
4ec2e92d
LC
879@cindex build hook
880@item --no-build-hook
881Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
882
883The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
884which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
885builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
886
bd5e766b
LC
887@item --cache-failures
888Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
889
30d9aa54
LC
890When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
891to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
892--clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
893@xref{Invoking guix gc}.
894
bd5e766b
LC
895@item --cores=@var{n}
896@itemx -c @var{n}
897Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
898as available.
899
6efc160e 900The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
e49951eb
MW
901as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
902guix build}).
bd5e766b
LC
903
904The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
905in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
906parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
907
908@item --max-jobs=@var{n}
909@itemx -M @var{n}
910Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
f6526eb3
LC
911@code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
912locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
913Setup}), or simply fail.
bd5e766b 914
ecf84b7c
LC
915@item --rounds=@var{N}
916Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
917consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
918setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
919(@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
920
bd5e766b
LC
921@item --debug
922Produce debugging output.
923
924This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
925overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
e49951eb 926@command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
bd5e766b
LC
927
928@item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
929Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
930
931Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
932they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
933and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
934Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
935needs.
936
937@item --disable-chroot
938Disable chroot builds.
939
940Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1e2644bb
LC
941processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
942though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
943account.
bd5e766b
LC
944
945@item --disable-log-compression
946Disable compression of the build logs.
947
1da983b9
LC
948Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
949@var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
950them with bzip2 by default. This option disables that.
951
ab3893d7
LC
952@item --disable-deduplication
953@cindex deduplication
bd5e766b
LC
954Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
955
1da983b9 956By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
ab3893d7
LC
957if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
958the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
4988dd40 959noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
ab3893d7
LC
960input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
961this optimization.
1da983b9 962
6e37066e
LC
963@item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
964Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
965derivations.
966
967When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
968available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
969meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are GC roots.
970
971@item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
972Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
973corresponding to live outputs.
974
975When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
976derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
977outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
978items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
979
980Note that when both @code{--gc-keep-derivations} and
981@code{--gc-keep-outputs} are used, the effect is to keep all the build
982prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time
983tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of whether these
984prerequisites are live. This is convenient for developers since it
985saves rebuilds or downloads.
986
bd5e766b
LC
987@item --impersonate-linux-2.6
988On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
989kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
990
991This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
992on the kernel version number.
993
994@item --lose-logs
995Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
ce33631f 996@code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
bd5e766b
LC
997
998@item --system=@var{system}
999Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1000architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1001@code{x86_64-linux}.
b8d2aa26
LC
1002
1003@item --listen=@var{socket}
1004Listen for connections on @var{socket}, the file name of a Unix-domain
1005socket. The default socket is
1006@file{@var{localstatedir}/daemon-socket/socket}. This option is only
1007useful in exceptional circumstances, such as if you need to run several
1008daemons on the same machine.
bd5e766b
LC
1009@end table
1010
1011
0e2d0213
LC
1012@node Application Setup
1013@section Application Setup
1014
85e57214
LC
1015When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than GuixSD---a
1016so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1017get everything in place. Here are some of them.
0e2d0213
LC
1018
1019@subsection Locales
1020
5c3c1427 1021@anchor{locales-and-locpath}
0e2d0213 1022@cindex locales, when not on GuixSD
5c3c1427 1023@vindex LOCPATH
85e57214 1024@vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
0e2d0213
LC
1025Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the host system's locale
1026data. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
85e57214
LC
1027available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1028variable:
0e2d0213
LC
1029
1030@example
1031$ guix package -i glibc-locales
85e57214 1032$ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
0e2d0213
LC
1033@end example
1034
1035Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1036locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1037110@tie{}MiB. Alternately, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1038limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1039
85e57214
LC
1040The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1041(@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1042Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1043
1044@enumerate
1045@item
1046@code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by Guix's libc, and not by the libc
1047provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
f9b9a033 1048to make sure the foreign distro's programs will not end up loading
85e57214
LC
1049incompatible locale data.
1050
1051@item
1052libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1053@code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1054should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1055different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1056data in the right format.
1057@end enumerate
1058
1059This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1060versions may be incompatible.
1061
0e2d0213
LC
1062@subsection X11 Fonts
1063
4988dd40 1064The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
0e2d0213
LC
1065load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. Guix's
1066@code{fontconfig} package looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1067by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1068to display fonts, you will have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1069Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
8fe5b1d1 1070@code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
0e2d0213 1071
5c36edc8
LC
1072To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1073graphical applications, consider installing
1074@code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1075has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1076Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1077for Chinese languages:
1078
1079@example
1080guix package -i font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1081@end example
1082
6d97319c
AK
1083@subsection Emacs Packages
1084
1085When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1086either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1087sub-directories of
1088@file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1089directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1090packages and storing all their files in a single directory may be not
1091reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1092directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1093the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1094Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1095
1096By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1097are placed, so you don't need to perform any configuration. If, for
1098some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1099with Guix, you can do it by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1100option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1101
0e2d0213
LC
1102@c TODO What else?
1103
eeaf4427
LC
1104@c *********************************************************************
1105@node Package Management
1106@chapter Package Management
1107
f8348b91 1108The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
eeaf4427
LC
1109remove software packages, without having to know about their build
1110procedure or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
1111features.
1112
1113This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the package
c1941588 1114management tools it provides. Two user interfaces are provided for
c554de89
AK
1115routine package management tasks: A command-line interface described below
1116(@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix package}}), as well as a visual user
1117interface in Emacs described in a subsequent chapter (@pxref{Emacs Interface}).
eeaf4427
LC
1118
1119@menu
1120* Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
e49951eb 1121* Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
c4202d60 1122* Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
760c60d6 1123* Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
e49951eb 1124* Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
f651b477 1125* Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
760c60d6 1126* Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
eeaf4427
LC
1127@end menu
1128
1129@node Features
1130@section Features
1131
1132When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
1133own directory---something that resembles
9a130e19
AK
1134@file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string
1135(note that Guix comes with an Emacs extension to shorten those file
081145cf 1136names, @pxref{Emacs Prettify}.)
eeaf4427
LC
1137
1138Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
1139@dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
821b0015
LC
1140use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
1141@code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
eeaf4427 1142
821b0015 1143For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
eeaf4427 1144@file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
834129e0 1145@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
821b0015
LC
1146@code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
1147simply continues to point to
834129e0 1148@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
821b0015 1149coexist on the same system without any interference.
eeaf4427 1150
e49951eb
MW
1151The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
1152packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on those per-user
821b0015 1153profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
eeaf4427
LC
1154
1155The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
1156operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
ba55b1cb 1157the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
e49951eb 1158@command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
eeaf4427
LC
1159or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
1160profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
1161
1162In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
1163for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
1164out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
4af2447e
LC
1165of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
1166system configuration is subject to transactional upgrades and roll-back
1167(@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
eeaf4427
LC
1168
1169All those packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
1170Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by the user
fe8ff028 1171profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
e49951eb 1172(@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
fe8ff028
LC
1173generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
1174collected.
eeaf4427 1175
e900c503
LC
1176@cindex reproducibility
1177@cindex reproducible builds
eeaf4427
LC
1178Finally, Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
1179management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
834129e0 1180Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
eeaf4427
LC
1181inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
1182scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
1183given package installation matches the current state of their
e900c503
LC
1184distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
1185thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
1186is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
1187machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
eeaf4427 1188
c4202d60 1189@cindex substitutes
eeaf4427 1190This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
c4202d60 1191deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
18f2887b 1192available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
c4202d60
LC
1193downloads it and unpacks it;
1194otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
1195(@pxref{Substitutes}).
eeaf4427 1196
f5fd4fd2
LC
1197Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
1198developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
1199a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
1200package, without having to manually install the package's dependencies
1201in their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1202
e49951eb
MW
1203@node Invoking guix package
1204@section Invoking @command{guix package}
eeaf4427 1205
e49951eb 1206The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
eeaf4427
LC
1207install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
1208previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
1209and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
1210is:
1211
1212@example
e49951eb 1213guix package @var{options}
eeaf4427
LC
1214@end example
1215
ba55b1cb 1216Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
eeaf4427 1217the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
99bd74d5 1218previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
eeaf4427
LC
1219want to roll back.
1220
6447738c
MW
1221For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
1222@code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
1223
1224@example
1225guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
1226@end example
1227
99bd74d5
LC
1228@command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
1229whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
1230passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
1231(@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
1232
b9e5c0a9 1233For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
0ec1af59 1234created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
b9e5c0a9
LC
1235current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
1236@file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
1237variable, and so on.
d664f1b4
LC
1238@cindex search paths
1239If you are not using the Guix System Distribution, consider adding the
1240following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
1241Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
1242shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
1243
1244@example
1245GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" \
1246source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
1247@end example
b9e5c0a9 1248
4379c35b
LC
1249In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
1250a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
1251to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
0ec1af59
LC
1252@code{@var{localstatedir}/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
1253@var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
4379c35b
LC
1254@code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
1255@file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
1256started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
1257package}.
0ec1af59
LC
1258
1259The @var{options} can be among the following:
1260
eeaf4427
LC
1261@table @code
1262
6447738c
MW
1263@item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
1264@itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
1265Install the specified @var{package}s.
eeaf4427 1266
6447738c 1267Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
eeaf4427 1268@code{guile}, or a package name followed by a hyphen and version number,
724311a2
LC
1269such as @code{guile-1.8.8} or simply @code{guile-1.8} (in the latter
1270case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
1271
1272If no version number is specified, the
dc5669cd
MW
1273newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
1274may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
6e721c4d 1275package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils-2.22:lib}
e7f34eb0
LC
1276(@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
1277name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
1278distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
eeaf4427 1279
461572cc
LC
1280@cindex propagated inputs
1281Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
21461f27
LC
1282that automatically get installed along with the required package
1283(@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
1284@code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
1285package definitions).
461572cc 1286
21461f27 1287@anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
461572cc
LC
1288An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
1289the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
1290Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
1291in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
1292also been explicitly installed independently.
1293
ba7ea5ce 1294Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
5924080d 1295variables for their search paths (see explanation of
ba7ea5ce 1296@code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
5924080d
LC
1297environment variable definitions are reported here.
1298
ef010c0f 1299@c XXX: keep me up-to-date
5924080d 1300Finally, when installing a GNU package, the tool reports the
ef010c0f
LC
1301availability of a newer upstream version. In the future, it may provide
1302the option of installing directly from the upstream version, even if
1303that version is not yet in the distribution.
1304
5d4b411f
LC
1305@item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
1306@itemx -e @var{exp}
1307Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
1308
1309@var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
1310@code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
1311between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
1312@code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
1313
1314Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
1315package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
1316multiple-output package.
1317
0d279400
DT
1318@item --install-from-file=@var{file}
1319@itemx -f @var{file}
1320Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
1321
1322As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
1323(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
1324
1325@example
1326@verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
1327@end example
1328
1329Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{package.scm} file
1330in the root of their project's source tree that can be used to test
1331development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
1332(@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1333
6447738c
MW
1334@item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
1335@itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
1336Remove the specified @var{package}s.
eeaf4427 1337
6447738c 1338As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
13ed095c
LC
1339and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
1340@code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
1341@code{glibc}.
1342
6447738c
MW
1343@item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1344@itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1345Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
1346specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
d5f01e48 1347@var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
eeaf4427 1348
f651b477
LC
1349Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
1350in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
1351you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
1352pull}).
1353
d5f01e48
MW
1354@item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1355When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
1356upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
1357upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
1358substring ``emacs'':
1359
1360@example
1361$ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
1362@end example
1363
99bd74d5 1364@item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
1b676447 1365@itemx -m @var{file}
99bd74d5
LC
1366@cindex profile declaration
1367@cindex profile manifest
1368Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
1b676447
DT
1369returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
1370
99bd74d5
LC
1371This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
1372constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
1373commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
1374control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
1375so on.
1376
1377@c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
1378@var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
1379of packages:
1b676447 1380
99bd74d5 1381@findex packages->manifest
1b676447 1382@example
99bd74d5 1383(use-package-modules guile emacs)
1b676447
DT
1384
1385(packages->manifest
99bd74d5
LC
1386 (list emacs
1387 guile-2.0
1b676447 1388 ;; Use a specific package output.
99bd74d5 1389 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
1b676447
DT
1390@end example
1391
24e262f0
LC
1392@item --roll-back
1393Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
1394the last transaction.
1395
1396When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
1397before any other actions.
1398
d9307267 1399When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
4b2bc804
NK
1400installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
1401generation}, which contains no files apart from its own meta-data.
d9307267 1402
82fe08ed
LC
1403Installing, removing, or upgrading packages from a generation that has
1404been rolled back to overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the
1405history of a profile's generations is always linear.
1406
b3bb82f1
AK
1407@item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
1408@itemx -S @var{pattern}
1409Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
1410
1411@var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
1412with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
1413specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
1414the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
1415@code{--switch-generation=+1}.
1416
1417The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
1418@code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
1419not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
1420exist, the current generation will not be changed.
1421
dbc31ab2 1422@item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
5924080d
LC
1423@cindex search paths
1424Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
1425needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
1426variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
1427of the installed packages.
1428
1429For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
1430environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
1431libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
1432Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
1433library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
1434suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
1435@code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
1436
dbc31ab2
LC
1437The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
1438shell:
1439
1440@example
1441$ eval `guix package --search-paths`
1442@end example
1443
1444@var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
1445meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
1446be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
1447variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
1448
fc2d2339
LC
1449This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
1450of several profiles. Consider this example:
1451
1452@example
1453$ guix package -p foo -i guile
1454$ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
1455$ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
1456@end example
1457
1458The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
1459variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
1460@file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
1461
1462
eeaf4427
LC
1463@item --profile=@var{profile}
1464@itemx -p @var{profile}
1465Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
1466
70915c1a
LC
1467@item --verbose
1468Produce verbose output. In particular, emit the environment's build log
1469on the standard error port.
1470
eeaf4427
LC
1471@item --bootstrap
1472Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
1473useful to distribution developers.
1474
1475@end table
1476
e49951eb 1477In addition to these actions @command{guix package} supports the
733b4130
LC
1478following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
1479availability of packages:
eeaf4427 1480
733b4130
LC
1481@table @option
1482
acc08466
NK
1483@item --search=@var{regexp}
1484@itemx -s @var{regexp}
b110869d 1485@cindex searching for packages
5763ad92 1486List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
299112d3
LC
1487@var{regexp}. Print all the meta-data of matching packages in
1488@code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
1489GNU recutils manual}).
acc08466 1490
299112d3
LC
1491This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
1492command, for instance:
1493
1494@example
e49951eb 1495$ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version
299112d3
LC
1496name: glibc
1497version: 2.17
1498
1499name: libgc
1500version: 7.2alpha6
1501@end example
acc08466 1502
a12d92f5
LC
1503Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
1504terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
1505
1506@example
1507$ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
1508name: elfutils
1509
1510name: gmp
1511@dots{}
1512@end example
1513
db5a9444
LC
1514It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s}
1515flags. For example, the following command returns a list of board
1516games:
1517
1518@example
1519$ guix package -s '\<board\>' -s game | recsel -p name
1520name: gnubg
1521@dots{}
1522@end example
1523
1524If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
1525that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
1526around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
1527keyboards.
1528
b110869d
LC
1529And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
1530for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
1531libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
1532
1533@example
1534$ guix package -s crypto -s library | \
1535 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
1536@end example
1537
1538@noindent
1539@xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
1540information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
1541
2aa6efb0
CR
1542@item --show=@var{package}
1543Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
1544@code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
1545recutils manual}).
1546
1547@example
1548$ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
1549name: python
1550version: 2.7.6
1551
1552name: python
1553version: 3.3.5
1554@end example
1555
1556You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
1557specific version of it:
1558@example
1559$ guix package --show=python-3.3.5 | recsel -p name,version
1560name: python
1561version: 3.3.5
1562@end example
1563
1564
1565
733b4130
LC
1566@item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
1567@itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
bd9bde1c
LC
1568List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
1569most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
1570specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
733b4130
LC
1571
1572For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1573tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
1574is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
1575@code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
1576the store.
1577
64fc89b6
LC
1578@item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
1579@itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
5763ad92 1580List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
a1ba8475
LC
1581(@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
1582installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
64fc89b6
LC
1583
1584For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
6e721c4d
LC
1585its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
1586Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
64fc89b6 1587
f566d765
LC
1588@item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1589@itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
1590Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
1591generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
4b2bc804
NK
1592installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
1593shown.
f566d765
LC
1594
1595For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1596tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
1597that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
1598location of this package in the store.
1599
1600When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
1601generations. Valid patterns include:
1602
1603@itemize
1604@item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
1605generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
1606the first one.
1607
1608And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
1609specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
1610
1611@item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
1612specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
1613a range must be lesser than its end.
1614
1615It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
1616@code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
1617second one.
1618
1619@item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
1620or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
d7ddb257
LC
1621duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
1622that are up to 20 days old.
f566d765
LC
1623@end itemize
1624
b7884ca3
NK
1625@item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1626@itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
d7ddb257
LC
1627When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
1628one.
b7884ca3
NK
1629
1630This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
d7ddb257
LC
1631When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
1632@var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
1633specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
1634deletes generations that are more than one month old.
1635
391bdd8f
LC
1636If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
1637zeroth generation is never deleted.
b7884ca3 1638
1bb9900a
LC
1639Note that deleting generations prevents roll-back to them.
1640Consequently, this command must be used with care.
1641
733b4130 1642@end table
eeaf4427 1643
70ee5642
LC
1644Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
1645processes, it supports all the common build options that @command{guix
1646build} supports (@pxref{Invoking guix build, common build options}).
1647
c4202d60
LC
1648@node Substitutes
1649@section Substitutes
1650
1651@cindex substitutes
1652@cindex pre-built binaries
1653Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
1654can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
1655server. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they are
1656substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
1657substitute is much faster than building things locally.
1658
1659Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
1660(@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
1661pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
1662also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
1663
1664The @code{hydra.gnu.org} server is a front-end to a build farm that
1665builds packages from the GNU distribution continuously for some
32950fc8
AK
1666architectures, and makes them available as substitutes (@pxref{Emacs
1667Hydra}, for information on how to query the continuous integration
1668server). This is the
f8a8e0fe
LC
1669default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
1670@option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
1671(@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
1672or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
1673(@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
1674option}).
c4202d60
LC
1675
1676@cindex security
1677@cindex digital signatures
1678To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org}, you
1679must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
1680imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
1681archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{hydra.gnu.org} to not
1682be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
1683
1684This public key is installed along with Guix, in
1685@code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
1686the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
1687make sure you checked the GPG signature of
1688@file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
1689Then, you can run something like this:
1690
1691@example
1692# guix archive --authorize < hydra.gnu.org.pub
1693@end example
1694
1695Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
1696should change from something like:
1697
1698@example
1699$ guix build emacs --dry-run
1700The following derivations would be built:
1701 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
1702 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
1703 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
1704 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
1705@dots{}
1706@end example
1707
1708@noindent
1709to something like:
1710
1711@example
1712$ guix build emacs --dry-run
1713The following files would be downloaded:
1714 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
1715 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
1716 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
1717 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
1718@dots{}
1719@end example
1720
1721@noindent
1722This indicates that substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} are usable and
1723will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
1724
1725Guix ignores substitutes that are not signed, or that are not signed by
ef27aa9c 1726one of the keys listed in the ACL. It also detects and raises an error
c4202d60
LC
1727when attempting to use a substitute that has been tampered with.
1728
e0c941fe
LC
1729@vindex http_proxy
1730Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP. The @code{http_proxy} environment
1731variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
1732honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
1733@code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
1734@command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
1735@emph{absolutely no effect}.
1736
c4202d60
LC
1737The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
1738@code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
1739guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
1740@code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
1741build}, and other command-line tools.
1742
1743
1744Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
1745mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
1746determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
1747weaknesses. While using @code{hydra.gnu.org} substitutes can be
1748convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
1749their own build farm, such that @code{hydra.gnu.org} is less of an
8ce229fc
LC
1750interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
1751build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
1752of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
c4202d60
LC
1753
1754Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
1755(@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
1756package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
1757a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
d23c20f1
LC
1758integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
1759help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
1760finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
a8d65643
LC
1761challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
1762build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
1763are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
1764@command{guix build --check}}).
c4202d60
LC
1765
1766In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
1767binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
1768like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
1769
1770
6e721c4d
LC
1771@node Packages with Multiple Outputs
1772@section Packages with Multiple Outputs
1773
1774@cindex multiple-output packages
1775@cindex package outputs
1776
1777Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
1778source package leads exactly one directory in the store. When running
1779@command{guix package -i glibc}, one installs the default output of the
1780GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
1781can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
1782default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
1783libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
1784files.
1785
1786Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
1787produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
1788instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
1789installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
1790To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
1791separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
1792which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
1793
1794@example
1795guix package -i glib
1796@end example
1797
1798The command to install its documentation is:
1799
1800@example
1801guix package -i glib:doc
1802@end example
1803
1804Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
1805For instance, the WordNet package install both command-line tools and
1806graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
1807library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
1808libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
1809output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
fcc58db6
LC
1810who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
1811can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
88856916 1812@command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
6e721c4d
LC
1813
1814There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
91ef73d4
LC
1815Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
1816possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
1817@code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
1818Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
1819the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
1820guix package}).
6e721c4d 1821
eeaf4427 1822
e49951eb
MW
1823@node Invoking guix gc
1824@section Invoking @command{guix gc}
fe8ff028
LC
1825
1826@cindex garbage collector
1827Packages that are installed but not used may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
e49951eb 1828The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
c22eb992
LC
1829collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
1830the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
1831files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
fe8ff028
LC
1832
1833The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
834129e0 1834@file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
fe8ff028
LC
1835cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
1836deleted. The set of garbage collector roots includes default user
e49951eb
MW
1837profiles, and may be augmented with @command{guix build --root}, for
1838example (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
fe8ff028 1839
1bb9900a
LC
1840Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
1841often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
1842package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
1843is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
1844(@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
1845
e49951eb 1846The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
fe8ff028 1847used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
7770aafc
LC
1848files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
1849information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
1850options are as follows:
fe8ff028
LC
1851
1852@table @code
1853@item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
1854@itemx -C [@var{min}]
834129e0 1855Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
fe8ff028
LC
1856sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
1857specified.
1858
1859When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
1860@var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
4a44d7bb
LC
1861suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
1862(@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
fe8ff028
LC
1863
1864When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
1865
1866@item --delete
1867@itemx -d
1868Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
1869arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
1870they are still live.
1871
30d9aa54
LC
1872@item --list-failures
1873List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
1874
1875This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
1876@option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
1877@option{--cache-failures}}).
1878
1879@item --clear-failures
1880Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
1881
1882Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
1883@option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
1884
fe8ff028
LC
1885@item --list-dead
1886Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
1887store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
1888
1889@item --list-live
1890Show the list of live store files and directories.
ba8b732d
LC
1891
1892@end table
1893
1894In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
1895
1896@table @code
1897
1898@item --references
1899@itemx --referrers
1900List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
1901as arguments.
1902
8e59fdd5
LC
1903@item --requisites
1904@itemx -R
fcc58db6 1905@cindex closure
8e59fdd5
LC
1906List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
1907include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
1908of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
1909@dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
1910
fcc58db6 1911@xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of an
88856916
LC
1912element's closure. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
1913the graph of references.
fcc58db6 1914
fe8ff028
LC
1915@end table
1916
7770aafc
LC
1917Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
1918store and to control disk usage.
1919
1920@table @option
1921
1922@item --verify[=@var{options}]
1923@cindex integrity, of the store
1924@cindex integrity checking
1925Verify the integrity of the store.
1926
1927By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
1928daemon's database actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
1929
1930When provided, @var{options} must a comma-separated list containing one
1931or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
1932
1933When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon will compute the
1934content hash of each store item and compare it against its hash in the
1935database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
1936traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
1937long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
1938
1939@cindex repairing the store
1940Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
1941causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
1942substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
1943atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
1944system administrator.
1945
1946@item --optimize
1947@cindex deduplication
1948Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
1949@dfn{deduplication}.
1950
1951The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
1952import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
1953(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
1954this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
1955@code{--disable-deduplication}.
1956
1957@end table
eeaf4427 1958
f651b477
LC
1959@node Invoking guix pull
1960@section Invoking @command{guix pull}
1961
1962Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
1963the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
1964that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
1965pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
1966descriptions, and deploys it.
1967
1968On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
1969versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
1970the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
1971version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
ef54b61d
AV
1972become available@footnote{Under the hood, @command{guix pull} updates
1973the @file{~/.config/guix/latest} symbolic link to point to the latest
1974Guix, and the @command{guix} command loads code from there.}.
f651b477
LC
1975
1976The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
1977but it supports the following options:
1978
1979@table @code
1980@item --verbose
1981Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
1982
ab5d72ad
LC
1983@item --url=@var{url}
1984Download the source tarball of Guix from @var{url}.
1985
1986By default, the tarball is taken from its canonical address at
1987@code{gnu.org}, for the stable branch of Guix.
1988
f651b477
LC
1989@item --bootstrap
1990Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
1991useful to Guix developers.
1992@end table
1993
760c60d6
LC
1994
1995@node Invoking guix archive
1996@section Invoking @command{guix archive}
1997
1998The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
1999from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them.
2000In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
2001to another machine's store. For example, to transfer the @code{emacs}
2002package to a machine connected over SSH, one would run:
2003
2004@example
56607088 2005guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
760c60d6
LC
2006@end example
2007
87236aed 2008@noindent
56607088
LC
2009Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
2010to another like this:
2011
2012@example
2013guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
2014 ssh the-machine guix-archive --import
2015@end example
2016
2017@noindent
2018However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
2019profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
2020@code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the target
2021machine's store. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
2022items are missing from the target's store.
87236aed 2023
760c60d6 2024Archives are stored in the ``Nix archive'' or ``Nar'' format, which is
0dbd88db
LC
2025comparable in spirit to `tar', but with a few noteworthy differences
2026that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
2027recording all Unix meta-data for each file, the Nar format only mentions
2028the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
2029and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
2030entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
2031the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
2032deterministic.
2033
2034When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
2035and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
2036verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
2037signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
760c60d6
LC
2038@c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
2039
2040The main options are:
2041
2042@table @code
2043@item --export
2044Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
2045resulting archive to the standard output.
2046
56607088
LC
2047Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
2048@code{--recursive} is passed.
2049
2050@item -r
2051@itemx --recursive
2052When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
2053archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
2054Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
2055of the exported store items.
2056
760c60d6
LC
2057@item --import
2058Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
2059therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
f82cc5fd
LC
2060signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
2061keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
554f26ec 2062
87236aed
LC
2063@item --missing
2064Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
2065and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
2066the store.
2067
554f26ec 2068@item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
f82cc5fd 2069@cindex signing, archives
554f26ec
LC
2070Generate a new key pair for the daemons. This is a prerequisite before
2071archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
2072usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
2073generate the key pair.
2074
2075The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
2076@file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
867d8473
LC
2077key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
2078an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
2079versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
2080Alternately, @var{parameters} can specify
554f26ec
LC
2081@code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
2082public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
2083Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
f82cc5fd
LC
2084
2085@item --authorize
2086@cindex authorizing, archives
2087Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
2088The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
2089same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
2090
2091The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
2092@file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
2093@url{http://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
2094s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
2095@url{http://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
2096(SPKI)}.
c6f8e9dd
LC
2097
2098@item --extract=@var{directory}
2099@itemx -x @var{directory}
2100Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
2101(@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
2102low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
2103
2104For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
2105served by @code{hydra.gnu.org} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
2106
2107@example
2108$ wget -O - \
2109 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
2110 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
2111@end example
2112
2113Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
2114by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
2115and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
2116@emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
2117unsafe.
2118
2119The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
2120archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
2121
760c60d6
LC
2122@end table
2123
2124To export store files as an archive to the standard output, run:
2125
2126@example
2127guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
2128@end example
2129
2130@var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
2131specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2132package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
2133containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
2134output of @code{emacs}:
2135
2136@example
834129e0 2137guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
760c60d6
LC
2138@end example
2139
2140If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
2141automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
2142same options that can be passed to the @command{guix build} command
70ee5642 2143(@pxref{Invoking guix build, common build options}).
760c60d6 2144
c554de89
AK
2145@c *********************************************************************
2146@include emacs.texi
760c60d6 2147
568717fd
LC
2148@c *********************************************************************
2149@node Programming Interface
2150@chapter Programming Interface
2151
3dc1970d
LC
2152GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
2153define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
2154write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
2155familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
2156its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
2157turned into concrete build actions.
2158
ba55b1cb 2159Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
3dc1970d 2160standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
834129e0 2161@file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
3dc1970d
LC
2162setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
2163build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
2164
2165@cindex derivation
2166Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
2167store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
2168provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
2169representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
2170which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
49ad317a
LC
2171assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
2172that build results @emph{derive} from them.
3dc1970d
LC
2173
2174This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
2175package definitions.
2176
568717fd 2177@menu
b860f382 2178* Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
7458bd0a 2179* Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
b860f382
LC
2180* The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
2181* Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
2182* The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
21b679f6 2183* G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
568717fd
LC
2184@end menu
2185
2186@node Defining Packages
2187@section Defining Packages
2188
3dc1970d
LC
2189The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
2190@code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
2191example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
2192package looks like this:
2193
2194@example
e7f34eb0
LC
2195(define-module (gnu packages hello)
2196 #:use-module (guix packages)
2197 #:use-module (guix download)
2198 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
a6dcdcac
SB
2199 #:use-module (guix licenses)
2200 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
b22a12fd 2201
79f5dd59 2202(define-public hello
3dc1970d
LC
2203 (package
2204 (name "hello")
17d8e33f 2205 (version "2.10")
3dc1970d 2206 (source (origin
17d8e33f
ML
2207 (method url-fetch)
2208 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
2209 ".tar.gz"))
2210 (sha256
2211 (base32
2212 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
3dc1970d 2213 (build-system gnu-build-system)
7458bd0a 2214 (arguments `(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
3dc1970d 2215 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
7458bd0a
LC
2216 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
2217 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
3dc1970d 2218 (home-page "http://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
b22a12fd 2219 (license gpl3+)))
3dc1970d
LC
2220@end example
2221
2222@noindent
2223Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
e7f34eb0 2224of the various fields here. This expression binds variable @code{hello}
3dc1970d
LC
2225to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
2226(@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
2227This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
2228@code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
2229returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
2230
2f7d2d91
LC
2231With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
2232the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
2233@code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
2234
e7f34eb0
LC
2235In the example above, @var{hello} is defined into a module of its own,
2236@code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
2237necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
2238modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
2239the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2240
3dc1970d
LC
2241There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
2242
2243@itemize
2244@item
a2bf4907
LC
2245The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
2246(@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
3dc1970d
LC
2247Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
2248meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
2249
2250The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
2251the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
2252
2253The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
2254being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
2255integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
6c365eca 2256base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
210cc920
LC
2257@code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
2258hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
3dc1970d 2259
f9cc8971
LC
2260@cindex patches
2261When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
2262listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
2263Scheme expression to modify the source code.
2264
3dc1970d
LC
2265@item
2266@cindex GNU Build System
7458bd0a
LC
2267The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
2268package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
2269represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
2270configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
2271make && make check && make install} command sequence.
2272
2273@item
2274The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
2275(@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
2276@var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
2277@code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
3dc1970d
LC
2278
2279@item
2280The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
2281build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
2282input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
2283variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
2284
2285Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
2286be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
7458bd0a 2287of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
3dc1970d
LC
2288
2289However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
2290@code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
2291unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
2292@end itemize
2293
87eafdbd
TUBK
2294@xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
2295
2f7d2d91 2296Once a package definition is in place, the
e49951eb 2297package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
39bee8a2
LC
2298tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). You can easily jump back to the
2299package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
2300(@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
2301@xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
b4f5e0e8
CR
2302more information on how to test package definitions, and
2303@ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
2304for style conformance.
2305
7458bd0a
LC
2306Eventually, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
2307can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
2308(@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
3dc1970d
LC
2309
2310Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
2311object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
834129e0 2312That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
ba55b1cb 2313The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
3dc1970d
LC
2314@code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
2315
2316@deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
59688fc4
LC
2317Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
2318(@pxref{Derivations}).
3dc1970d
LC
2319
2320@var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
2321must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
2322@code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
2323must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
2324(@pxref{The Store}).
2325@end deffn
568717fd 2326
9c1edabd
LC
2327@noindent
2328@cindex cross-compilation
2329Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
2330package for some other system:
2331
2332@deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
2333 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
59688fc4
LC
2334Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
2335@var{system} to @var{target}.
9c1edabd
LC
2336
2337@var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
2338and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
2339(@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU configuration triplets,, configure, GNU
2340Configure and Build System}).
2341@end deffn
2342
87eafdbd
TUBK
2343@menu
2344* package Reference :: The package data type.
2345* origin Reference:: The origin data type.
2346@end menu
2347
2348
2349@node package Reference
2350@subsection @code{package} Reference
2351
2352This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
2353declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2354
2355@deftp {Data Type} package
2356This is the data type representing a package recipe.
2357
2358@table @asis
2359@item @code{name}
2360The name of the package, as a string.
2361
2362@item @code{version}
2363The version of the package, as a string.
2364
2365@item @code{source}
2366An origin object telling how the source code for the package should be
2367acquired (@pxref{origin Reference}).
2368
2369@item @code{build-system}
2370The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
2371Systems}).
2372
2373@item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
2374The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
2375list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
2376
2377@item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
70650c68
LC
2378@itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2379@itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2380@cindex inputs, of packages
2381These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
2382tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
2383first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
2384and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
2385defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
2386more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies 3
2387inputs:
87eafdbd 2388
70650c68
LC
2389@example
2390`(("libffi" ,libffi)
2391 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
2392 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
2393@end example
2394
2395@cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
2396The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
2397necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
2398dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
2399architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
2400are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
2401
2402@code{native-inputs} is typically where you would list tools needed at
2403build time but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
2404Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
2405this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
2406
2407@anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
2408Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
2409specified packages will be force-installed alongside the package they
2410belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
2411package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
2412propagated inputs.)
21461f27 2413
e0508b6b
LC
2414For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
2415another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
2416one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
2417
2418Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for
2419languages that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin
2420to ELF's @code{RUNPATH}; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, GHC, and
2421more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
2422library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
2423listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
87eafdbd 2424
87eafdbd
TUBK
2425@item @code{self-native-input?} (default: @code{#f})
2426This is a Boolean field telling whether the package should use itself as
2427a native input when cross-compiling.
2428
2429@item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
2430The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
2431Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
2432
2433@item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2434@itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2435A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
2436search-path environment variables honored by the package.
2437
2438@item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
2439This must either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
2440@dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
2441for details.
2442
2443@item @code{synopsis}
2444A one-line description of the package.
2445
2446@item @code{description}
2447A more elaborate description of the package.
2448
2449@item @code{license}
2450The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)}.
2451
2452@item @code{home-page}
2453The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
2454
2455@item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
2456The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
2457@code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
2458
2459@item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
2460The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
2461
2462@item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
2463The source location of the package. It's useful to override this when
2464inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
2465automatically corrected.
2466@end table
2467@end deftp
2468
2469
2470@node origin Reference
2471@subsection @code{origin} Reference
2472
2473This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
2474declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2475
2476@deftp {Data Type} origin
2477This is the data type representing a source code origin.
2478
2479@table @asis
2480@item @code{uri}
2481An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
2482the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
2483@var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
2484values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
2485
2486@item @code{method}
2487A procedure that will handle the URI.
2488
2489Examples include:
2490
2491@table @asis
2492@item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
2493download a file the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
2494@code{uri} field;
2495
2496@item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
2497clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
2498specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
2499@code{git-reference} looks like this:
2500
2501@example
2502(git-reference
2503 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
2504 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
2505@end example
2506@end table
2507
2508@item @code{sha256}
2509A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
2510@code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
2511base-32 string.
2512
2513@item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
2514The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
2515@code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
2516the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
2517used. For version control checkouts, it's recommended to provide the
2518file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
2519
2520@item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
2521A list of file names containing patches to be applied to the source.
2522
2523@item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
2524A quoted piece of code that will be run in the source directory to make
2525any modifications, which is sometimes more convenient than a patch.
2526
2527@item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
2528A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
2529command.
2530
2531@item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
2532Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
2533@code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
2534such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
2535
2536@item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
2537A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
2538process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
2539
2540@item @code{imported-modules} (default: @code{'()})
2541The list of Guile modules to import in the patch derivation, for use by
2542the @code{snippet}.
2543
2544@item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
2545The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
2546this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
2547@end table
2548@end deftp
2549
9c1edabd 2550
7458bd0a
LC
2551@node Build Systems
2552@section Build Systems
2553
2554@cindex build system
2555Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
2556that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
2557field represents the build procedure of the package, as well implicit
2558dependencies of that build procedure.
2559
2560Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
2561create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
2562module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
2563
f5fd4fd2 2564@cindex bag (low-level package representation)
0d5a559f
LC
2565Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
2566@dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
2567ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
2568a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
2569that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
2570representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
2571
7458bd0a
LC
2572Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
2573definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
2574(@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
2575(@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
2576Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
2577evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
2578by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
2579
2580The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
2581standard build procedure for GNU packages and many other packages. It
2582is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
2583
2584@defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
2585@var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
2586thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
2587standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
2588
2589@cindex build phases
2590In a nutshell, packages using it configured, built, and installed with
2591the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
2592command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
2593All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
2594notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
2595modules for more details about the build phases.}:
2596
2597@table @code
2598@item unpack
2599Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
2600extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
2601to the build tree, and enter that directory.
2602
2603@item patch-source-shebangs
2604Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
2605store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
2606@code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
2607
2608@item configure
2609Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
2610as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
2611by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
2612
2613@item build
2614Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
0917e80e 2615@code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
7458bd0a
LC
2616(the default), build with @code{make -j}.
2617
2618@item check
2619Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
2620@code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
2621@code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
2622check -j}.
2623
2624@item install
2625Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
2626
2627@item patch-shebangs
2628Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
2629
2630@item strip
2631Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
2632is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
2633(@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
2634@end table
2635
2636@vindex %standard-phases
2637The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
2638@var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
2639@var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
2640procedure implements the actual phase.
2641
2642The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
2643@code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
2644
2645@example
2646#:phases (alist-delete 'configure %standard-phases)
2647@end example
2648
9bf404e9 2649means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
7458bd0a
LC
2650@code{configure} phase.
2651
2652In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
2653for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
2654Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
2655build-system gnu)} module for a complete list.) We call these the
2656@dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions don't
2657have to mention them.
2658@end defvr
2659
2660Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
2661conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
2662of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
2663implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
2664executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
2665
2666@defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
2667This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
2668implements the build procedure for packages using the
2669@url{http://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
2670
2671It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
2672Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
2673parameter.
9849cfc1
LC
2674
2675The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
2676passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
2677parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
2678it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
2679debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
2680@code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
7458bd0a
LC
2681@end defvr
2682
3afcf52b
FB
2683@defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
2684This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
2685is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
2686
2687This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
2688@var{gnu-build-system}:
2689
2690@table @code
2691@item glib-or-gtk-wrap
2692The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs found under
2693@file{bin/} are able to find GLib's ``schemas'' and
2694@uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
2695modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
2696that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
2697environment variables.
2698
73aa8ddb
LC
2699It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
2700process by listing their names in the
2701@code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
2702when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
2703where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
2704GLib and GTK+.
2705
3afcf52b
FB
2706@item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
2707The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all GLib's
2708@uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
2709GSettings schemas} are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
2710@command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
2711@code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
2712The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
2713specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
2714@end table
2715
2716Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
2717@end defvr
2718
7458bd0a
LC
2719@defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
2720This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
2721implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
2722packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
2723then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
2724
2725For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
2726it takes care of wrapping these programs so their @code{PYTHONPATH}
2727environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
2728
2729Which Python package is used can be specified with the @code{#:python}
2730parameter.
2731@end defvr
2732
2733@defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
2734This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
2d2a53fc
EB
2735implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
2736consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
2737followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
2738@code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
2739@code{make} and @code{make install}; depending on which of
2740@code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
2741distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
2742and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
2743preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
2744@code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
2745
2746The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
2747passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
2748@code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
7458bd0a
LC
2749
2750Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
2751@end defvr
2752
f8f3bef6
RW
2753@defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
2754This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
2755implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://r-project.org, R}
2756packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
2757INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
2758@code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
2759are run after installation using the R function
2760@code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
2761@end defvr
2762
c08f9818
DT
2763@defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
2764This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
2765implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
2766involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
2767
5dc87623
DT
2768The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
2769typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
2770developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
2771the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
2772repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
2773tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
2774a traditional source release tarball.
e83c6d00 2775
c08f9818 2776Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6e9f2913
PP
2777parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
2778command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
c08f9818 2779@end defvr
7458bd0a 2780
a677c726
RW
2781@defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
2782This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
2783implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
2784phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
2785implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
2786script.
2787
2788The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
2789Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
2790@code{#:python} parameter.
2791@end defvr
2792
14dfdf2e
FB
2793@defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
2794This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
2795implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
2796involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
2797--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
2798Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
2799install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
2800compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
2801Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
2802addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
2803running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
2804is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
2805the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
2806not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
2807
2808Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
a54bd6d7 2809parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
14dfdf2e
FB
2810@end defvr
2811
e9137a53
FB
2812@defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
2813This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
2814implements an installation procedure similar to the one of Emacs' own
2815packaging system (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
2816
2817It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
2818byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
2819packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
2820documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
2821package is installed in its own directory under
2822@file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
2823@end defvr
2824
7458bd0a
LC
2825Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
2826``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
2827it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
2828and does not have a notion of build phases.
2829
2830@defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
2831This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
2832
2833This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
2834must be a Scheme expression that builds the package's output(s)---as
2835with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
2836@code{build-expression->derivation}}).
2837@end defvr
2838
568717fd
LC
2839@node The Store
2840@section The Store
2841
e531ac2a
LC
2842@cindex store
2843@cindex store paths
2844
2845Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is where derivations that have been
834129e0 2846successfully built are stored---by default, under @file{/gnu/store}.
e531ac2a 2847Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store paths}. The
4988dd40 2848store has an associated database that contains information such as the
e531ac2a
LC
2849store paths referred to by each store path, and the list of @emph{valid}
2850store paths---paths that result from a successful build.
2851
2852The store is always accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
2853(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
2854connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send it requests, and
2855read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
2856
2857The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
2858daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below.
2859
2860@deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{file}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
2861Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{file}. When
2862@var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
2863extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
2864operate, should the disk become full. Return a server object.
2865
2866@var{file} defaults to @var{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
2867location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
2868@end deffn
2869
2870@deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
2871Close the connection to @var{server}.
2872@end deffn
2873
2874@defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
2875This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
2876where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
2877@end defvr
2878
2879Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
2880argument.
2881
2882@deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
2883Return @code{#t} when @var{path} is a valid store path.
2884@end deffn
2885
cfbf9160 2886@deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
e531ac2a
LC
2887Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
2888path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
2889resulting store path.
2890@end deffn
2891
874e6874 2892@deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{server} @var{derivations}
59688fc4
LC
2893Build @var{derivations} (a list of @code{<derivation>} objects or
2894derivation paths), and return when the worker is done building them.
2895Return @code{#t} on success.
874e6874
LC
2896@end deffn
2897
b860f382
LC
2898Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
2899monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
2900more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
2901Store Monad}).
2902
e531ac2a
LC
2903@c FIXME
2904@i{This section is currently incomplete.}
568717fd
LC
2905
2906@node Derivations
2907@section Derivations
2908
874e6874
LC
2909@cindex derivations
2910Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
2911are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contain the
2912following pieces of information:
2913
2914@itemize
2915@item
2916The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
2917directory in the store, but may produce more.
2918
2919@item
2920The inputs of the derivations, which may be other derivations or plain
2921files in the store (patches, build scripts, etc.)
2922
2923@item
2924The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
2925
2926@item
2927The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
2928to be passed.
2929
2930@item
2931A list of environment variables to be defined.
2932
2933@end itemize
2934
2935@cindex derivation path
2936Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
2937the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
2938both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
2939name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
2940paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
2941procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
2942Store}).
2943
2944The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
2945derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
2946otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
2947a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
2948
1909431c
LC
2949@deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
2950 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
2096ef47 2951 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
1909431c 2952 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
4a6aeb67
LC
2953 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
2954 [#:substitutable? #t]
59688fc4
LC
2955Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
2956@code{<derivation>} object.
874e6874 2957
2096ef47 2958When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
874e6874 2959@dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
36bbbbd1
LC
2960known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
2961@var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
2962file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
2963containing this output.
5b0c9d16 2964
858e9282 2965When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
5b0c9d16
LC
2966name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
2967path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
2968a simple text format.
1909431c 2969
b53be755
LC
2970When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
2971or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to.
2972
c0468155
LC
2973When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
2974denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
2975daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
2976to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
2977use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
2978derivations that download files.
2979
1909431c
LC
2980When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
2981good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
2982(@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
2983where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
4a6aeb67
LC
2984
2985When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
2986derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
2987useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
2988host CPU instruction set.
874e6874
LC
2989@end deffn
2990
2991@noindent
2992Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
2993@var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
2994to a Bash executable in the store:
2995
2996@lisp
2997(use-modules (guix utils)
2998 (guix store)
2999 (guix derivations))
3000
59688fc4
LC
3001(let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
3002 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
3003 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
3004 (derivation store "foo"
3005 bash `("-e" ,builder)
21b679f6 3006 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
59688fc4 3007 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
834129e0 3008@result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
874e6874
LC
3009@end lisp
3010
21b679f6
LC
3011As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
3012better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
3013best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
3014``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
6621cdb6 3015information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
21b679f6
LC
3016
3017Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
3018derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
3019@code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
3020is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
874e6874 3021
dd1a5a15
LC
3022@deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
3023 @var{name} @var{exp} @
3024 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
3025 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
36bbbbd1 3026 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
63a42824 3027 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
4a6aeb67 3028 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
874e6874
LC
3029Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
3030builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
3031@code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
3032@code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
3033modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
3034compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
3035@var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
3036gnu-build-system))}.
3037
3038@var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
3039to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
3040to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
3041Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
3042and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
3043terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
3044@var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
3045
3046@var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
3047@var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
3048@code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
9c629a27 3049
63a42824 3050See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
4a6aeb67
LC
3051@var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references}, @var{local-build?},
3052and @var{substitutable?}.
874e6874
LC
3053@end deffn
3054
3055@noindent
3056Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
3057containing one file:
3058
3059@lisp
3060(let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
834129e0 3061 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
874e6874
LC
3062 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
3063 (lambda (p)
3064 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
dd1a5a15 3065 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
874e6874 3066
834129e0 3067@result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
874e6874
LC
3068@end lisp
3069
568717fd 3070
b860f382
LC
3071@node The Store Monad
3072@section The Store Monad
3073
3074@cindex monad
3075
3076The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
3077sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
3078argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
3079side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
3080
3081The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
3082carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
3083functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
3084latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
3085and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
3086
3087@cindex monadic values
3088@cindex monadic functions
3089This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
3090provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
3091useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
3092construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
3093(in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
561fb6c3 3094computations (here computations include accesses to the store.) Values
b860f382
LC
3095in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
3096@dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
3097@dfn{monadic procedures}.
3098
3099Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
3100
3101@example
45adbd62
LC
3102(define (sh-symlink store)
3103 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
3104 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
3105 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
3106 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
3107 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
3108 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
b860f382
LC
3109@end example
3110
c6f30b81
LC
3111Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
3112as a monadic function:
b860f382
LC
3113
3114@example
45adbd62 3115(define (sh-symlink)
b860f382 3116 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
c6f30b81
LC
3117 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
3118 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3119 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
3120 #$output))))
b860f382
LC
3121@end example
3122
c6f30b81
LC
3123There several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
3124parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
3125@code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
3126procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
3127is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
3128
3129As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
3130omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
3131(@pxref{G-Expressions}):
3132
3133@example
3134(define (sh-symlink)
3135 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3136 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
3137 #$output)))
3138@end example
b860f382 3139
7ce21611
LC
3140@c See
3141@c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
3142@c for the funny quote.
3143Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
3144said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
3145So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
3146@code{run-with-store}:
b860f382
LC
3147
3148@example
8e9aa37f
CAW
3149(run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
3150@result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
b860f382
LC
3151@end example
3152
b9b86078
LC
3153Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends Guile's REPL with
3154new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
3155@code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former, is used
3156to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
3157
3158@example
3159scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
3160$1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3161@end example
3162
3163The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
3164automatically run through the store:
3165
3166@example
3167scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
3168store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
3169$2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3170store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
3171$3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
3172store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
3173scheme@@(guile-user)>
3174@end example
3175
3176@noindent
3177Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
3178@code{store-monad} REPL.
3179
e87f0591
LC
3180The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
3181the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
b860f382
LC
3182
3183@deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
3184Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
3185in @var{monad}.
3186@end deffn
3187
3188@deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
3189Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
3190@end deffn
3191
751630c9 3192@deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
b860f382 3193@dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
751630c9
LC
3194procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
3195referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
3196Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
3197Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
3198in this example:
3199
3200@example
3201(run-with-state
3202 (with-monad %state-monad
3203 (>>= (return 1)
3204 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
3205 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
3206 'some-state)
3207
3208@result{} 4
3209@result{} some-state
3210@end example
b860f382
LC
3211@end deffn
3212
3213@deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3214 @var{body} ...
3215@deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3216 @var{body} ...
3217Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
3218@var{body}. The form (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the
3219``normal'' value @var{val}, as per @code{let}.
3220
3221@code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
3222(@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3223@end deffn
3224
405a9d4e
LC
3225@deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
3226Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
3227returning the result of the last expression.
3228
3229This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
3230monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
3231@code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
3232@end deffn
3233
561fb6c3
LC
3234@cindex state monad
3235The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
3236allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
3237monadic procedure calls.
3238
3239@defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
3240The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
3241the state that is threaded.
3242
3243Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
3244in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
3245increments the current state value:
3246
3247@example
3248(define (square x)
3249 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
3250 (mbegin %state-monad
3251 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
3252 (return (* x x)))))
3253
3254(run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
3255@result{} (0 1 4)
3256@result{} 3
3257@end example
3258
3259When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
3260value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
3261@end defvr
3262
3263@deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
3264Return the current state as a monadic value.
3265@end deffn
3266
3267@deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
3268Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
3269monadic value.
3270@end deffn
3271
3272@deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
3273Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
3274and return the previous state as a monadic value.
3275@end deffn
3276
3277@deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
3278Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
3279The state is assumed to be a list.
3280@end deffn
3281
3282@deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
3283Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
3284state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
3285@end deffn
3286
e87f0591
LC
3287The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
3288store)} module, is as follows.
b860f382
LC
3289
3290@defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
561fb6c3
LC
3291The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
3292
3293Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
3294effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
3295passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
b860f382
LC
3296@end defvr
3297
3298@deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
3299Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
3300open store connection.
3301@end deffn
3302
ad372953 3303@deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
b860f382 3304Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
ad372953
LC
3305containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
3306resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
45adbd62
LC
3307@end deffn
3308
0a90af15
LC
3309@deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3310 [#:recursive? #t]
3311Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
3312@var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
3313@var{name} is omitted.
3314
3315When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
3316recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
3317is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
3318
3319The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
3320
3321@example
3322(run-with-store (open-connection)
3323 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
3324 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
3325 (return (list a b))))
3326
3327@result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
3328@end example
3329
3330@end deffn
3331
e87f0591
LC
3332The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
3333monadic procedures:
3334
b860f382 3335@deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
4231f05b
LC
3336 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
3337 [#:output "out"] Return as a monadic
b860f382
LC
3338value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
3339directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
4231f05b
LC
3340of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
3341true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
b860f382
LC
3342@end deffn
3343
b860f382 3344@deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
4231f05b
LC
3345@deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
3346 @var{target} [@var{system}]
3347Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
3348@code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
b860f382
LC
3349@end deffn
3350
3351
21b679f6
LC
3352@node G-Expressions
3353@section G-Expressions
3354
3355@cindex G-expression
3356@cindex build code quoting
3357So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
3358to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
3359Those build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
3360build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
3361(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
3362
3363@cindex strata of code
3364It should come as no surprise that we like to write those build actions
3365in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
3366code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
ef4ab0a4
LC
3367Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
3368Kiselyov, who has written insightful
3369@url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
3370on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
3371@dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
3372to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
3373performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
3374@command{make}, etc.
21b679f6
LC
3375
3376To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
3377embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
3378code as data, and Scheme's homoiconicity---code has a direct
3379representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
3380Scheme's normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism to construct build
3381expressions.
3382
3383The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
3384S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
3385@dfn{gexps}, consist essentially in three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
3386@code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
3387@code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable respectively to
3388@code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing}
3389(@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile, GNU Guile
3390Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
3391
3392@itemize
3393@item
3394Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
3395processes.
3396
3397@item
b39fc6f7
LC
3398When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
3399inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
3400introduced.
ff40e9b7 3401
21b679f6
LC
3402@item
3403Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
3404and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
3405processes that use them.
3406@end itemize
3407
c2b84676 3408@cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
343eacbe
LC
3409This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
3410objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
c2b84676
LC
3411derivations or files in the store can be defined,
3412such that these objects can also be inserted
343eacbe
LC
3413into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level object that can be
3414inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
3415add files to the store and refer to them in
558e8b11
LC
3416derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
3417below.)
b39fc6f7 3418
21b679f6
LC
3419To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
3420
3421@example
3422(define build-exp
3423 #~(begin
3424 (mkdir #$output)
3425 (chdir #$output)
aff8ce7c 3426 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
21b679f6
LC
3427 "list-files")))
3428@end example
3429
3430This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
3431derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
3432@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
3433
3434@example
3435(gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
3436@end example
3437
e20fd1bf 3438As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
21b679f6
LC
3439substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
3440actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
3441the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
3442output)}) is replaced by a string containing the derivation's output
667b2508
LC
3443directory name.
3444
3445@cindex cross compilation
3446In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
3447references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
3448host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
3449@code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
3450native package build:
3451
3452@example
3453(gexp->derivation "vi"
3454 #~(begin
3455 (mkdir #$output)
3456 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
3457 "-s"
3458 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
3459 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
3460 #:target "mips64el-linux")
3461@end example
3462
3463@noindent
3464In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
3465that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
3466cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
3467
3468The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
21b679f6
LC
3469
3470@deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
3471@deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
3472Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
3473or more of the following forms:
3474
3475@table @code
3476@item #$@var{obj}
3477@itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
b39fc6f7
LC
3478Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
3479supported types, for example a package or a
21b679f6
LC
3480derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
3481output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
3482
b39fc6f7
LC
3483If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
3484objects are substituted similarly.
21b679f6
LC
3485
3486If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
3487dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
3488
3489If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
3490
b39fc6f7
LC
3491@item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
3492@itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
21b679f6 3493This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
b39fc6f7
LC
3494@var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
3495multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
21b679f6 3496
667b2508
LC
3497@item #+@var{obj}
3498@itemx #+@var{obj}:output
3499@itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
3500@itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
3501Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
3502build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
3503
21b679f6
LC
3504@item #$output[:@var{output}]
3505@itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
3506Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
3507output when @var{output} is omitted.
3508
3509This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
3510
3511@item #$@@@var{lst}
3512@itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
3513Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
3514containing list.
3515
667b2508
LC
3516@item #+@@@var{lst}
3517@itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
3518Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
3519@var{lst}.
3520
21b679f6
LC
3521@end table
3522
3523G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
3524of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
3525@end deffn
3526
3527@deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
3528Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
3529@end deffn
3530
3531G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
3532some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
3533below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
3534information about monads.)
3535
3536@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
ce45eb4c 3537 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
21b679f6
LC
3538 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3539 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
4684f301 3540 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
c8351d9a 3541 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
c0468155 3542 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
0309e1b0 3543 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
4a6aeb67 3544 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
21b679f6 3545Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
0309e1b0
LC
3546@var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
3547stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
3548it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
3549to by @var{exp}.
21b679f6 3550
ce45eb4c
LC
3551Make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
3552@var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
3553@var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
21b679f6
LC
3554the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
3555build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
3556
ce45eb4c
LC
3557@var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
3558applicable.
3559
b53833b2
LC
3560When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
3561following forms:
3562
3563@example
3564(@var{file-name} @var{package})
3565(@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
3566(@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
3567(@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
3568(@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
3569@end example
3570
3571The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
3572an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
3573@var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
3574text format.
3575
c8351d9a
LC
3576@var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
3577In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
3578refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
3579
e20fd1bf 3580The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
21b679f6
LC
3581@end deffn
3582
343eacbe 3583@cindex file-like objects
e1c153e0
LC
3584The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
3585@code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
3586@dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
3587these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
343eacbe
LC
3588
3589@example
3590#~(system* (string-append #$glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
3591 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
3592@end example
3593
3594The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
3595to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
3596@code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
3597@file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
3598does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
3599@code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
3600content is directly passed as a string.
3601
d9ae938f
LC
3602@deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3603 [#:recursive? #t]
3604Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
9d3994f7
LC
3605object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
3606up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
3607the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
d9ae938f
LC
3608
3609When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
3610designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
3611permission bits are kept.
3612
3613This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
3614procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
3615@end deffn
3616
558e8b11
LC
3617@deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
3618Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
3619@var{content} (a string) to be added to the store.
3620
3621This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
3622@end deffn
3623
91937029
LC
3624@deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
3625 [#:modules '()] [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
3626Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
3627directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{modules} specifies the set of
3628modules visible in the execution context of @var{gexp}. @var{options}
3629is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
3630
3631This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
3632@end deffn
3633
21b679f6
LC
3634@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp}
3635Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
3636@var{guile} with @var{modules} in its search path.
3637
3638The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
3639command:
3640
3641@example
3642(use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
3643
3644(gexp->script "list-files"
3645 #~(execl (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
3646 "ls"))
3647@end example
3648
3649When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
e20fd1bf 3650@code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
21b679f6
LC
3651executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
3652
3653@example
3654#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
3655!#
3656(execl (string-append "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls")
3657 "ls")
3658@end example
3659@end deffn
3660
15a01c72
LC
3661@deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
3662 [#:modules '()] [#:guile #f]
3663Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
3664runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
3665script, and @var{modules} is the list of modules visible to that script.
3666
3667This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
3668@end deffn
3669
21b679f6
LC
3670@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp}
3671Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
3672
3673The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
3674or a subset thereof.
3675@end deffn
1ed19464 3676
e1c153e0
LC
3677@deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp}
3678Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
3679@var{exp}.
3680
3681This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
3682@end deffn
3683
1ed19464
LC
3684@deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
3685Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
3686containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
d9ae938f
LC
3687strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
3688derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
3689references to all these.
1ed19464
LC
3690
3691This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
3692to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
3693case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
3694like this:
3695
3696@example
3697(define (profile.sh)
3698 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
3699 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
3700 (text-file* "profile.sh"
3701 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
3702 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
3703@end example
3704
3705In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
3706will references @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
3707preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
3708@end deffn
21b679f6 3709
b751cde3
LC
3710@deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
3711Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
3712@var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
3713as in:
3714
3715@example
3716(mixed-text-file "profile"
3717 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
3718@end example
3719
3720This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
3721@end deffn
3722
21b679f6
LC
3723Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
3724also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
3725meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
3726@code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
3727
c2b84676
LC
3728@cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
3729Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
3730to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
3731yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
3732item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
3733
3734@deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
3735 [#:target #f]
3736Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
3737corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
3738@var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
3739has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
3740@end deffn
3741
21b679f6 3742
568717fd
LC
3743@c *********************************************************************
3744@node Utilities
3745@chapter Utilities
3746
210cc920
LC
3747This section describes tools primarily targeted at developers and users
3748who write new package definitions. They complement the Scheme
3749programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
3750
568717fd 3751@menu
37166310 3752* Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
39bee8a2 3753* Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
210cc920 3754* Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
37166310 3755* Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
2f7d2d91 3756* Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
37166310 3757* Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
b4f5e0e8 3758* Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
fcc58db6 3759* Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
88856916 3760* Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
372c4bbc 3761* Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
aff8ce7c 3762* Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
d23c20f1 3763* Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
32efa254 3764* Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
568717fd
LC
3765@end menu
3766
e49951eb
MW
3767@node Invoking guix build
3768@section Invoking @command{guix build}
568717fd 3769
e49951eb 3770The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
6798a8e4
LC
3771their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
3772does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
e49951eb 3773@command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
6798a8e4
LC
3774it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
3775
3776The general syntax is:
c78bd12b
LC
3777
3778@example
e49951eb 3779guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
c78bd12b
LC
3780@end example
3781
3782@var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
5401dd75
LC
3783the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
3784@code{coreutils-8.20}, or a derivation such as
834129e0 3785@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
e7f34eb0
LC
3786package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
3787for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3788
3789Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
3790Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
3791disambiguation among several same-named packages or package variants is
3792needed.
c78bd12b
LC
3793
3794The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
3795
3796@table @code
3797
34a1783f
DT
3798@item --file=@var{file}
3799@itemx -f @var{file}
3800
3801Build the package or derivation that the code within @var{file}
3802evaluates to.
3803
3804As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
3805(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
3806
3807@example
3808@verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
3809@end example
3810
c78bd12b
LC
3811@item --expression=@var{expr}
3812@itemx -e @var{expr}
ac5de156 3813Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
c78bd12b 3814
5401dd75 3815For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
c78bd12b
LC
3816guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
3817version 1.8 of Guile.
3818
56b82106
LC
3819Alternately, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
3820as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
3821(@pxref{G-Expressions}).
3822
3823Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
ac5de156
LC
3824(@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
3825monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
3826
c78bd12b
LC
3827@item --source
3828@itemx -S
3829Build the packages' source derivations, rather than the packages
3830themselves.
3831
e49951eb 3832For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
834129e0 3833@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is GCC's source tarball.
c78bd12b 3834
f9cc8971
LC
3835The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
3836code snippets specified in the package's @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
3837Packages}).
3838
2cdfe13d
EB
3839@item --sources
3840Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
3841dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
3842of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
3843eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
3844of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
3845optional argument values:
3846
3847@table @code
3848@item package
3849This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
3850as the @code{--source} option.
3851
3852@item all
3853Build all packages' source derivations, including any source that might
3854be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
3855
3856@example
3857$ guix build --sources tzdata
3858The following derivations will be built:
3859 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
3860 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
3861@end example
3862
3863@item transitive
3864Build all packages' source derivations, as well as all source
3865derivations for packages' transitive inputs. This can be used e.g. to
3866prefetch package source for later offline building.
3867
3868@example
3869$ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
3870The following derivations will be built:
3871 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
3872 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
3873 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
3874 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
3875 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
3876 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
3877@dots{}
3878@end example
3879
3880@end table
3881
c78bd12b
LC
3882@item --system=@var{system}
3883@itemx -s @var{system}
3884Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
3885the host's system type.
3886
3887An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
3888different personalities. For instance, passing
3889@code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system allows users
3890to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
3891
e55ec43d
LC
3892@item --target=@var{triplet}
3893@cindex cross-compilation
3894Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
3895as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU
3896configuration triplets,, configure, GNU Configure and Build System}).
3897
7f3673f2
LC
3898@item --with-source=@var{source}
3899Use @var{source} as the source of the corresponding package.
3900@var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
3901download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
3902
3903The ``corresponding package'' is taken to be one specified on the
3904command line whose name matches the base of @var{source}---e.g., if
3905@var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
3906package is @code{guile}. Likewise, the version string is inferred from
3907@var{source}; in the previous example, it's @code{2.0.10}.
3908
3909This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
3910one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
3911@file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
3912the @code{ed} package:
3913
3914@example
3915guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
3916@end example
3917
3918As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
3919candidates:
3920
3921@example
3922guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
3923@end example
3924
a43b55f1
LC
3925@dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
3926
3927@example
3928$ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
3929$ guix build guix --with-source=./guix
3930@end example
3931
a8d65643
LC
3932@anchor{build-check}
3933@item --check
3934@cindex determinism, checking
3935@cindex reproducibility, checking
3936Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
3937store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
3938identical.
3939
3940This mechanism allows you to check whether previously-installed
3941substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether a package's
3942build result is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
3943background information and tools.
3944
05962f29
LC
3945@item --no-grafts
3946Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
3947available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
3948information on grafts.
7f3673f2 3949
c78bd12b
LC
3950@item --derivations
3951@itemx -d
3952Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
3953packages.
3954
70ee5642
LC
3955@item --root=@var{file}
3956@itemx -r @var{file}
3957Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
3958collector root.
3959
3960@item --log-file
3f208ad7 3961Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
70ee5642
LC
3962@var{package-or-derivation}s, or raise an error if build logs are
3963missing.
3964
3965This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
3966instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
3967
3968@example
3969guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
3970guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
3971guix build --log-file guile
3972guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
3973@end example
3974
3f208ad7
LC
3975If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
3976passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
3977substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
70ee5642 3978
3f208ad7
LC
3979So for instance, let's say you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS
3980but you're actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
3981
3982@example
3983$ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
3984http://hydra.gnu.org/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
3985@end example
3986
3987You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
70ee5642
LC
3988@end table
3989
3990@cindex common build options
3991In addition, a number of options that control the build process are
3992common to @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds,
3993such as @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
3994following:
3995
3996@table @code
3997
300868ba
LC
3998@item --load-path=@var{directory}
3999@itemx -L @var{directory}
4000Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
4001(@pxref{Package Modules}).
4002
4003This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
4004the command-line tools.
4005
c78bd12b
LC
4006@item --keep-failed
4007@itemx -K
4008Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fail, its build
4009tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
4010the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
4011
f4953019
LC
4012@item --keep-going
4013@itemx -k
4014Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
4015all the builds have either completed or failed.
4016
4017The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
4018derivations has failed.
4019
c78bd12b
LC
4020@item --dry-run
4021@itemx -n
4022Do not build the derivations.
4023
56b1f4b7
LC
4024@item --fallback
4025When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
4026packages locally.
4027
f8a8e0fe
LC
4028@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
4029@anchor{client-substitute-urls}
4030Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
4031URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
4032(@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
4033
4034This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
4035they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
4036(@pxref{Substitutes}).
4037
c78bd12b 4038@item --no-substitutes
b5385b52 4039Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
c4202d60
LC
4040locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
4041(@pxref{Substitutes}).
c78bd12b 4042
5b74fe06
LC
4043@item --rounds=@var{n}
4044Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
4045consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
4046
4047This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
4048Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
4049practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
4050binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
4051
4052Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
4053so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
4054stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export},
4055then rebuilding, and finally comparing the two results.
4056
425b0bfc 4057@item --no-build-hook
4ec2e92d
LC
4058Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the daemon's ``build hook''
4059(@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
4060instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
425b0bfc 4061
969e678e
LC
4062@item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
4063When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
4064@var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
4065
002622b6
LC
4066@item --timeout=@var{seconds}
4067Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
4068@var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
4069
4070By default there is no timeout. This behavior can be restored with
4071@code{--timeout=0}.
4072
07ab4bf1
LC
4073@item --verbosity=@var{level}
4074Use the given verbosity level. @var{level} must be an integer between 0
4075and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of 4 or more
4076may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
4077
70ee5642
LC
4078@item --cores=@var{n}
4079@itemx -c @var{n}
4080Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
4081value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
bf421152 4082
f6526eb3
LC
4083@item --max-jobs=@var{n}
4084@itemx -M @var{n}
4085Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
4086guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
4087equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
4088
c78bd12b
LC
4089@end table
4090
e49951eb 4091Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
c78bd12b
LC
4092the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
4093module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
01d8ac64 4094derivations)} module.
c78bd12b 4095
16eb115e
DP
4096In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
4097@command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
4098building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
4099
4100@defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
4101Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
4102will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
4103@command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
4104below:
4105
4106@example
4107$ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
4108@end example
4109
847391fe
DP
4110These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
4111the parsed command-line options.
16eb115e
DP
4112@end defvr
4113
4114
39bee8a2
LC
4115@node Invoking guix edit
4116@section Invoking @command{guix edit}
4117
4118@cindex package definition, editing
4119So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
4120facilitates the life of packagers by pointing their editor at the source
4121file containing the definition of the specified packages. For instance:
4122
4123@example
4124guix edit gcc-4.8 vim
4125@end example
4126
4127@noindent
6237b9fa
LC
4128launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
4129@code{EDITOR} environment variable to edit the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.8.4
4130and that of Vim.
39bee8a2
LC
4131
4132If you are using Emacs, note that the Emacs user interface provides
6248e326
AK
4133similar functionality in the ``package info'' and ``package list''
4134buffers created by @kbd{M-x guix-search-by-name} and similar commands
4135(@pxref{Emacs Commands}).
39bee8a2
LC
4136
4137
210cc920
LC
4138@node Invoking guix download
4139@section Invoking @command{guix download}
4140
4141When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
4142the package's source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
4143hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
4144@command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
4145from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
4146in the store and its SHA256 hash.
4147
4148The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
4149when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
4150with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
4151downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
4152convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
4153eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4154
4155The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
4156package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
4157@code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
4158Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
537c8bb3
LC
4159they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
4160how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
4161GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
210cc920
LC
4162
4163The following option is available:
4164
4165@table @code
4166@item --format=@var{fmt}
4167@itemx -f @var{fmt}
4168Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
081145cf 4169information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
210cc920
LC
4170@end table
4171
6c365eca
NK
4172@node Invoking guix hash
4173@section Invoking @command{guix hash}
4174
210cc920 4175The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
6c365eca
NK
4176It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
4177distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
4178used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4179
4180The general syntax is:
4181
4182@example
4183guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
4184@end example
4185
4186@command{guix hash} has the following option:
4187
4188@table @code
4189
4190@item --format=@var{fmt}
4191@itemx -f @var{fmt}
210cc920 4192Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
6c365eca
NK
4193
4194Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
4195(@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
4196
4197If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
4198will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
4199in the definitions of packages.
4200
3140f2df
LC
4201@item --recursive
4202@itemx -r
4203Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
4204
4205In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
4206including its children if it is a directory. Some of @var{file}'s
4207meta-data is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
4208regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
4209executable or not. Meta-data such as time stamps has no impact on the
4210hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
4211@c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
4212@c it exists.
4213
6c365eca
NK
4214@end table
4215
2f7d2d91
LC
4216@node Invoking guix import
4217@section Invoking @command{guix import}
4218
4219@cindex importing packages
4220@cindex package import
4221@cindex package conversion
4222The @command{guix import} command is useful for people willing to add a
4223package to the distribution but who'd rather do as little work as
4224possible to get there---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
4225repositories from which it can ``import'' package meta-data. The result
4226is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
4227(@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4228
4229The general syntax is:
4230
4231@example
4232guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
4233@end example
4234
4235@var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
4236meta-data, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
4237options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
4238``importers'' are:
4239
4240@table @code
4241@item gnu
4242Import meta-data for the given GNU package. This provides a template
4243for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
4244source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
4245
4246Additional information such as the package's dependencies and its
4247license needs to be figured out manually.
4248
4249For example, the following command returns a package definition for
4250GNU@tie{}Hello:
4251
4252@example
4253guix import gnu hello
4254@end example
4255
4256Specific command-line options are:
4257
4258@table @code
4259@item --key-download=@var{policy}
4260As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
4261keys when verifying the package's signature. @xref{Invoking guix
4262refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
4263@end table
4264
4265@item pypi
4266@cindex pypi
4267Import meta-data from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
4268Index}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
4269@xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted
4270description available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all
4271the relevant information, including package dependencies.
4272
4273The command below imports meta-data for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
4274package:
4275
4276@example
4277guix import pypi itsdangerous
4278@end example
4279
3aae8145
DT
4280@item gem
4281@cindex gem
4282Import meta-data from @uref{https://rubygems.org/,
4283RubyGems}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be
4284installed. @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the
4285JSON-formatted description available at @code{rubygems.org} and includes
4286most relevant information, including runtime dependencies. There are
4287some caveats, however. The meta-data doesn't distinguish between
4288synopses and descriptions, so the same string is used for both fields.
4289Additionally, the details of non-Ruby dependencies required to build
4290native extensions is unavailable and left as an exercise to the
4291packager.
4292
4293The command below imports meta-data for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
4294
4295@example
4296guix import gem rails
4297@end example
4298
d45dc6da
EB
4299@item cpan
4300@cindex CPAN
4301Import meta-data from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
4302Information is taken from the JSON-formatted meta-data provided through
4303@uref{https://api.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
66392e47
EB
4304relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
4305should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
4306@code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
4307list of dependencies.
d45dc6da
EB
4308
4309The command command below imports meta-data for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
4310Perl module:
4311
4312@example
4313guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
4314@end example
4315
e1248602
RW
4316@item cran
4317@cindex CRAN
d0bd632f 4318@cindex Bioconductor
e1248602
RW
4319Import meta-data from @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
4320central repository for the @uref{http://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
4321statistical and graphical environment}.
4322
d0bd632f 4323Information is extracted from the package's @code{DESCRIPTION} file.
e1248602
RW
4324
4325The command command below imports meta-data for the @code{Cairo}
4326R package:
4327
4328@example
4329guix import cran Cairo
4330@end example
4331
d0bd632f
RW
4332When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, meta-data is imported from
4333@uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
4334packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
4335genomic data in bioinformatics.
4336
4337Information is extracted from a package's @code{DESCRIPTION} file
4338published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
4339
4340The command command below imports meta-data for the @code{GenomicRanges}
4341R package:
4342
4343@example
4344guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
4345@end example
4346
2f7d2d91
LC
4347@item nix
4348Import meta-data from a local copy of the source of the
4349@uref{http://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
4350relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
4351@uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
4352typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
4353command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
4354the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
4355package definition.
4356
4357When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
4358by their canonical upstream variant.
4359
961d0d2d
LC
4360Usually, you will first need to do:
4361
4362@example
4363export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
4364@end example
4365
4366@noindent
4367so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
4368
2f7d2d91
LC
4369As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
4370LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
4371bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
4372
4373@example
4374guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
4375@end example
863af4e1
FB
4376
4377@item hackage
4378@cindex hackage
4379Import meta-data from Haskell community's central package archive
4380@uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
4381Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
4382dependencies.
4383
4384Specific command-line options are:
4385
4386@table @code
a4154748
FB
4387@item --stdin
4388@itemx -s
4389Read a Cabal file from the standard input.
863af4e1
FB
4390@item --no-test-dependencies
4391@itemx -t
a4154748
FB
4392Do not include dependencies required by the test suites only.
4393@item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
4394@itemx -e @var{alist}
4395@var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
4396Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
4397@code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
4398The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
4399@code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
4400has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
4401associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
4402@samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc} respectively.
863af4e1
FB
4403@end table
4404
4405The command below imports meta-data for the latest version of the
a4154748
FB
4406@code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
4407specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
863af4e1
FB
4408
4409@example
a4154748 4410guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
863af4e1
FB
4411@end example
4412
4413A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
4414package name by a hyphen and a version number as in the following example:
4415
4416@example
4417guix import hackage mtl-2.1.3.1
4418@end example
7f74a931
FB
4419
4420@item elpa
4421@cindex elpa
4422Import meta-data from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
4423repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
4424
4425Specific command-line options are:
4426
4427@table @code
4428@item --archive=@var{repo}
4429@itemx -a @var{repo}
4430@var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
4431information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
4432are:
4433@itemize -
4434@item
840bd1d3 4435@uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
7f74a931
FB
4436identifier. This is the default.
4437
4438@item
840bd1d3 4439@uref{http://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
7f74a931
FB
4440@code{melpa-stable} identifier.
4441
4442@item
840bd1d3 4443@uref{http://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
7f74a931
FB
4444identifier.
4445@end itemize
4446@end table
2f7d2d91
LC
4447@end table
4448
4449The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
4450useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
4451is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
4452
37166310
LC
4453@node Invoking guix refresh
4454@section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
4455
4456The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
4457of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
4458provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
4459upstream version, like this:
4460
4461@example
4462$ guix refresh
4463gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
4464gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
4465@end example
4466
4467It does so by browsing each package's FTP directory and determining the
bcb571cb
LC
4468highest version number of the source tarballs therein. The command
4469knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
4470packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. The
4471are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
4472whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
4473extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
37166310
LC
4474
4475When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
4476update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those packages'
4477recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
4478each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
4479signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
4480using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
4481key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
4482attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
4483when it's successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
4484@command{guix refresh} reports an error.
4485
4486The following options are supported:
4487
4488@table @code
4489
2d7fc7da
LC
4490@item --expression=@var{expr}
4491@itemx -e @var{expr}
4492Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4493
4494This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
4495
4496@example
4497guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
4498@end example
4499
4500This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
4501the packages.)
4502
37166310
LC
4503@item --update
4504@itemx -u
38e16b49
LC
4505Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
4506usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
4507Guix Before It Is Installed}):
4508
4509@example
4510$ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core
4511@end example
4512
081145cf 4513@xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
37166310
LC
4514
4515@item --select=[@var{subset}]
4516@itemx -s @var{subset}
4517Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
4518@code{non-core}.
4519
4520The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
4521distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
4522else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
4523changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
4524all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
4525terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
4526
4527The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
4528typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
4529inconvenient.
4530
bcb571cb
LC
4531@item --type=@var{updater}
4532@itemx -t @var{updater}
7191adc5
AK
4533Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
4534list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
bcb571cb
LC
4535
4536@table @code
4537@item gnu
4538the updater for GNU packages;
e80c0f85
LC
4539@item gnome
4540the updater for GNOME packages;
bcb571cb 4541@item elpa
d882c235
LC
4542the updater for @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
4543@item cran
b9d044ef 4544the updater for @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
d0bd632f
RW
4545@item bioconductor
4546the updater for @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
bab020d7 4547@item pypi
b9d044ef 4548the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
bcb571cb
LC
4549@end table
4550
4551For instance, the following commands only checks for updates of Emacs
d882c235 4552packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and updates of CRAN packages:
bcb571cb
LC
4553
4554@example
7191adc5 4555$ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
d882c235 4556gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
bcb571cb
LC
4557gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
4558@end example
4559
37166310
LC
4560@end table
4561
4562In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
4563names, as in this example:
4564
4565@example
38e16b49 4566$ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc-4.8.4
37166310
LC
4567@end example
4568
4569@noindent
4570The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
4571@code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
4572effect in this case.
4573
7d193ec3
EB
4574When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
4575convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
4576should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
4577be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
4578
4579@table @code
4580
6ffa706b
AK
4581@item --list-updaters
4582@itemx -L
4583List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
4584
7d193ec3
EB
4585@item --list-dependent
4586@itemx -l
4587List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
4588result of upgrading one or more packages.
4589
4590@end table
4591
4592Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
4593@emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
4594an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
4595
4596@example
7779ab61
LC
4597$ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
4598Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
4599hop-2.4.0 geiser-0.4 notmuch-0.18 mu-0.9.9.5 cflow-1.4 idutils-4.6 @dots{}
7d193ec3
EB
4600@end example
4601
4602The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
4603for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
4604
f9230085
LC
4605The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
4606
4607@table @code
4608
f9230085
LC
4609@item --gpg=@var{command}
4610Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
4611for in @code{$PATH}.
4612
2bc53ba9
LC
4613@item --key-download=@var{policy}
4614Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
4615of:
4616
4617@table @code
4618@item always
4619Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
4620to the user's GnuPG keyring.
4621
4622@item never
4623Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
4624
4625@item interactive
4626When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
4627the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
4628@end table
4629
4630@item --key-server=@var{host}
4631Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
4632
f9230085
LC
4633@end table
4634
b4f5e0e8
CR
4635@node Invoking guix lint
4636@section Invoking @command{guix lint}
4637The @command{guix lint} is meant to help package developers avoid common
873c4085
LC
4638errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on a
4639given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
4640definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
4641@code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
4642
4643@table @code
4644@item synopsis
4645@itemx description
4646Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
4647descriptions and synopses.
4648
4649@item inputs-should-be-native
4650Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
4651
4652@item source
4653@itemx home-page
50f5c46d 4654@itemx source-file-name
873c4085 4655Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
50f5c46d
EB
4656invalid. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g. is not
4657just a version number or ``git-checkout'', and should not have a
4658@code{file-name} declared (@pxref{origin Reference}).
40a7d4e5 4659
5432734b
LC
4660@item cve
4661Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
4662Exposures (CVE) database
4663@uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
4664NIST}.
4665
40a7d4e5
LC
4666@item formatting
4667Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
4668use of tabulations, etc.
873c4085 4669@end table
b4f5e0e8
CR
4670
4671The general syntax is:
4672
4673@example
4674guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4675@end example
4676
4677If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
4678The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
4679
4680@table @code
4681
dd7c013d
CR
4682@item --checkers
4683@itemx -c
4684Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
4685names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
4686
b4f5e0e8
CR
4687@item --list-checkers
4688@itemx -l
4689List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
4690and exit.
4691
4692@end table
37166310 4693
fcc58db6
LC
4694@node Invoking guix size
4695@section Invoking @command{guix size}
4696
4697The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
4698disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
4699additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
4700single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
4701with Multiple Outputs}). These are the typical issues that
4702@command{guix size} can highlight.
4703
4704The command can be passed a package specification such as @code{gcc-4.8}
4705or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
4706example:
4707
4708@example
4709$ guix size coreutils
4710store item total self
4711/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23 70.0 13.9 19.8%
4712/gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.0.0a 55.3 2.5 3.6%
4713/gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 53.7 0.5 0.7%
4714/gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.46 53.2 0.3 0.5%
4715/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.4-lib 52.9 15.7 22.4%
4716/gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.21 37.2 37.2 53.1%
4717@end example
4718
4719@cindex closure
4720The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
4721Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
4722would be returned by:
4723
4724@example
4725$ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
4726@end example
4727
4728Here the output shows 3 columns next to store items. The first column,
4729labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
4730the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
4731dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
4732item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the item's size to the
4733space occupied by all the items listed here.
4734
4735In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
473670@tie{}MiB, half of which is taken by libc. (That libc represents a
4737large fraction of the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because it is
4738always available on the system anyway.)
4739
4740When the package passed to @command{guix size} is available in the
4741store, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
4742dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
4743-ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
4744Coreutils}).
4745
4746When the given package is @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
4747reports information based on information about the available substitutes
4748(@pxref{Substitutes}). This allows it to profile disk usage of store
4749items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
4750
a8f996c6 4751The available options are:
fcc58db6
LC
4752
4753@table @option
4754
d490d06e
LC
4755@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
4756Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
4757@xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
4758
a8f996c6
LC
4759@item --map-file=@var{file}
4760Write to @var{file} a graphical map of disk usage as a PNG file.
4761
4762For the example above, the map looks like this:
4763
4764@image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
4765produced by @command{guix size}}
4766
4767This option requires that
4768@uref{http://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
4769installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
4770the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
4771
fcc58db6
LC
4772@item --system=@var{system}
4773@itemx -s @var{system}
4774Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
4775
4776@end table
4777
88856916
LC
4778@node Invoking guix graph
4779@section Invoking @command{guix graph}
4780
4781@cindex DAG
4782Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
4783directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
4784mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command is
4785here to provide a visual representation of the DAG. @command{guix
4786graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
4787@uref{http://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
4788directly to Graphviz's @command{dot} command, for instance. The general
4789syntax is:
4790
4791@example
4792guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4793@end example
4794
4795For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
4796package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
4797dependencies:
4798
4799@example
4800guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
4801@end example
4802
4803The output looks like this:
4804
4805@image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
4806
4807Nice little graph, no?
4808
4809But there's more than one graph! The one above is concise: it's the
4810graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
4811grep, etc. It's often useful to have such a concise graph, but
4812sometimes you want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
4813several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of details:
4814
4815@table @code
4816@item package
4817This is the default type, the one we used above. It shows the DAG of
4818package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
4819filters out many details.
4820
4821@item bag-emerged
4822This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
4823
4824For instance, the following command:
4825
4826@example
4827guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
4828@end example
4829
4830... yields this bigger graph:
4831
4832@image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
4833
4834At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
4835@var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
4836
4837Now, note that the dependencies of those implicit inputs---that is, the
4838@dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
4839here, for conciseness.
4840
4841@item bag
4842Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
4843dependencies.
4844
38b92daa
LC
4845@item bag-with-origins
4846Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
4847
88856916
LC
4848@item derivations
4849This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
4850derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
4851the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
4852builds scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
4853
4854@end table
4855
4856All the above types correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
4857following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
4858
4859@table @code
4860@item references
4861This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
4862by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4863
4864If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
4865graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
4866@end table
4867
4868The available options are the following:
4869
4870@table @option
4871@item --type=@var{type}
4872@itemx -t @var{type}
4873Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
4874the values listed above.
4875
4876@item --list-types
4877List the supported graph types.
4c8f997a
LC
4878
4879@item --expression=@var{expr}
4880@itemx -e @var{expr}
4881Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4882
4883This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
4884
4885@example
4886guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
4887@end example
88856916
LC
4888@end table
4889
4890
372c4bbc
DT
4891@node Invoking guix environment
4892@section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4893
f5fd4fd2 4894@cindex reproducible build environments
fe36d84e 4895@cindex development environments
372c4bbc
DT
4896The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4897creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4898package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4899packages, builds all of the necessary inputs, and creates a shell
4900environment to use them.
4901
4902The general syntax is:
4903
4904@example
4905guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4906@end example
4907
fe36d84e
LC
4908The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4909GNU@tie{}Guile:
372c4bbc
DT
4910
4911@example
4912guix environment guile
4913@end example
4914
4915If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4916automatically builds them. The new shell's environment is an augmented
4917version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4918It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4919added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
4920environment in which the original environment variables have been unset,
50500f7c
LC
4921use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4922environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4923file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4924may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4925environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4926variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
4927@file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
4928@xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
4929details on Bash start-up files.}.
372c4bbc 4930
28de8d25
LC
4931@vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
4932@command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
4933variable in the shell it spaws. This allows users to, say, define a
4934specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
4935(@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
4936
4937@example
4938if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
4939then
4940 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
4941fi
4942@end example
4943
372c4bbc
DT
4944Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
4945union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
4946command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
4947and Emacs are available:
4948
4949@example
4950guix environment guile emacs
4951@end example
4952
1de2fe95
DT
4953Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
4954command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
4955command from the rest of the arguments:
372c4bbc
DT
4956
4957@example
1de2fe95 4958guix environment guile -- make -j4
372c4bbc
DT
4959@end example
4960
fe36d84e
LC
4961In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
4962packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
4963runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
4964NumPy:
4965
4966@example
1de2fe95 4967guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
fe36d84e
LC
4968@end example
4969
cc90fbbf
DT
4970Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
4971additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
4972are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
4973@code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
4974@code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
4975added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
4976packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
4977the following command creates a Guix development environment that
4978additionally includes Git and strace:
4979
4980@example
4981guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
4982@end example
4983
f535dcbe
DT
4984Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
4985possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
4986using Guix on a host distro that is not GuixSD, it is desirable to
4987prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
4988the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
4989a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
4990working directory are mounted:
4991
4992@example
4993guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
4994@end example
4995
0f252e26 4996@quotation Note
cfd35b4e 4997The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
0f252e26
DT
4998@end quotation
4999
fe36d84e 5000The available options are summarized below.
372c4bbc
DT
5001
5002@table @code
5003@item --expression=@var{expr}
5004@itemx -e @var{expr}
c9c282ce
DT
5005Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5006@var{expr} evaluates to.
372c4bbc 5007
fe36d84e
LC
5008For example, running:
5009
5010@example
5011guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5012@end example
5013
5014starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5015PETSc package.
5016
c9c282ce
DT
5017Running:
5018
5019@example
5c2b2f00 5020guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
c9c282ce
DT
5021@end example
5022
5023starts a shell with all the GuixSD base packages available.
5024
372c4bbc
DT
5025@item --load=@var{file}
5026@itemx -l @var{file}
c9c282ce
DT
5027Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5028within @var{file} evaluates to.
372c4bbc 5029
fe36d84e
LC
5030As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5031(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5032
5033@example
5034@verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5035@end example
5036
a54bd6d7
DT
5037@item --ad-hoc
5038Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5039@i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5040useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5041package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5042
5043For instance, the command:
5044
5045@example
1de2fe95 5046guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
a54bd6d7
DT
5047@end example
5048
5049runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5050available.
5051
417c39f1
LC
5052Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5053@code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl} but it is possible to ask for a
5054specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5055of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5056
cc90fbbf
DT
5057This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5058environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
5059as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
5060default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
5061that will be added to the environment directly.
5062
372c4bbc
DT
5063@item --pure
5064Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment.
5065This has the effect of creating an environment in which search paths
5066only contain package inputs.
5067
5068@item --search-paths
5069Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5070environment.
ce367ef3
LC
5071
5072@item --system=@var{system}
5073@itemx -s @var{system}
5074Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
f535dcbe
DT
5075
5076@item --container
5077@itemx -C
5078@cindex container
5079Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
56b6befb 5080directory outside the container is mapped inside the
f535dcbe
DT
5081container. Additionally, the spawned process runs as the current user
5082outside the container, but has root privileges in the context of the
5083container.
5084
5085@item --network
5086@itemx -N
5087For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5088Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5089device.
5090
5091@item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5092For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
5093as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
5094@var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5095point in the container.
5096
5097The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5098home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5099directory:
5100
5101@example
5102guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5103@end example
5104
5c2b2f00 5105@item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
f535dcbe
DT
5106For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
5107as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
5108@var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5109point in the container.
5110
5111The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5112home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
5113@file{/exchange} directory:
5114
5115@example
5116guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5117@end example
372c4bbc
DT
5118@end table
5119
5120It also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
5121build} supports (@pxref{Invoking guix build, common build options}).
5122
aff8ce7c
DT
5123@node Invoking guix publish
5124@section Invoking @command{guix publish}
5125
5126The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
8ce229fc
LC
5127their store with others, which can then use it as a substitute server
5128(@pxref{Substitutes}).
5129
5130When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
5131anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
5132that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
5133since the HTTP interface is compatible with Hydra, the software behind
5134the @code{hydra.gnu.org} build farm.
aff8ce7c
DT
5135
5136For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
5137their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
5138@command{guix publish} uses the system's signing key, which is only
5463fe51
LC
5139readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
5140@code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
aff8ce7c 5141
b18812b6
LC
5142The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
5143launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
5144guix archive}).
5145
aff8ce7c
DT
5146The general syntax is:
5147
5148@example
5149guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
5150@end example
5151
5152Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
5153spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
5154
5155@example
5156guix publish
5157@end example
5158
5159Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
5160archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
5161
5162@example
5163guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
5164@end example
5165
5166The following options are available:
5167
5168@table @code
5169@item --port=@var{port}
5170@itemx -p @var{port}
5171Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
5172
9e2292ef
LC
5173@item --listen=@var{host}
5174Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
5175accept connections from any interface.
5176
5463fe51
LC
5177@item --user=@var{user}
5178@itemx -u @var{user}
5179Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
5180server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
5181
aff8ce7c
DT
5182@item --repl[=@var{port}]
5183@itemx -r [@var{port}]
5184Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
8ce229fc
LC
5185Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
5186primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
aff8ce7c
DT
5187@end table
5188
1c52181f
LC
5189Enabling @command{guix publish} on a GuixSD system is a one-liner: just
5190add a call to @code{guix-publish-service} in the @code{services} field
5191of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service,
5192@code{guix-publish-service}}).
5193
d23c20f1
LC
5194
5195@node Invoking guix challenge
5196@section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
5197
5198@cindex reproducible builds
5199@cindex verifiable builds
5200
5201Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
5202code it claims to build? Is this package's build process deterministic?
5203These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
5204answer.
5205
5206The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
5207server (@pxref{Substitutes}), you'd rather @emph{verify} that it
5208provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
5209is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
5210independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
5211bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
5212obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
5213
5214We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
5215the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
5216directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
5217etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
5218one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
5219@command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
5220mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
5221any given store item.
5222
5223The command's output looks like this:
5224
5225@smallexample
5226$ guix challenge --substitute-urls="http://hydra.gnu.org http://guix.example.org"
5227updating list of substitutes from 'http://hydra.gnu.org'... 100.0%
5228updating list of substitutes from 'http://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
5229/gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
5230 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5231 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5232 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
5233/gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
5234 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
5235 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
5236 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
5237/gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
5238 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5239 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5240 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
5241@end smallexample
5242
5243@noindent
5244In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
5245determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
5246items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
5247all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
5248the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
5249
5250@cindex non-determinism, in package builds
5251As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
5252Conversely, @code{hydra.gnu.org} agrees with local builds, except in the
5253case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
5254non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
5255various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
5256packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
5257sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
5258results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
5259by inode number. See @uref{http://reproducible.debian.net/howto/}, for
5260more information.
5261
5262To find out what's wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
5263these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
5264
5265@example
5266$ wget -q -O - http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
5267 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
043f4698 5268$ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
d23c20f1
LC
5269@end example
5270
5271This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
5272local build, and the files resulting from the build on
5273@code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
5274diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
5275works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
5276is @uref{http://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
5277visualize differences for all kinds of files.
5278
5279Once you've done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
5280to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
5281hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
5282to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process, one that
5283involves not just Guix but a large part of the free software community.
5284In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
5285the problem.
5286
5287If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
5288whether @code{hydra.gnu.org} and other substitute servers obtain the
5289same build result as you did with:
5290
5291@example
5292$ guix challenge @var{package}
5293@end example
5294
5295@noindent
5296... where @var{package} is a package specification such as
5297@code{guile-2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
5298
5299The general syntax is:
5300
5301@example
5302guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
5303@end example
5304
5305The one option that matters is:
5306
5307@table @code
5308
5309@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5310Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
5311URLs to compare to.
5312
5313@end table
5314
5315
32efa254
DT
5316@node Invoking guix container
5317@section Invoking @command{guix container}
5318@cindex container
5319
5320@quotation Note
5321As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
5322is subject to radical change in the future.
5323@end quotation
5324
5325The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
5326running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
46c36586 5327``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
32efa254
DT
5328(@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
5329(@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
5330
5331The general syntax is:
5332
5333@example
5334guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
5335@end example
5336
5337@var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
5338@var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
5339
5340The following actions are available:
5341
5342@table @code
5343@item exec
5344Execute a command within the context of a running container.
5345
5346The syntax is:
5347
5348@example
5349guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
5350@end example
5351
5352@var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
5353@var{program} specifies an executable file name within the container's
5354root file system. @var{arguments} are the additional options that will
5355be passed to @var{program}.
5356
5357The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
5358GuixSD container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
5359process ID is 9001:
5360
5361@example
5362guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
5363@end example
5364
5365Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
5366must be the container's PID 1 or one of its child processes.
5367
5368@end table
5369
a1ba8475
LC
5370@c *********************************************************************
5371@node GNU Distribution
5372@chapter GNU Distribution
5373
3ca2731c 5374@cindex Guix System Distribution
4705641f 5375@cindex GuixSD
3ca2731c
LC
5376Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
5377free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
a1ba8475 5378@url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
3ca2731c 5379users of that software}.}. The
35ed9306
LC
5380distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
5381but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
5382an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). To distinguish
3ca2731c 5383between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as the Guix
4705641f 5384System Distribution, or GuixSD.
35ed9306
LC
5385
5386The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
5387Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
5388list of available packages can be browsed
093ae1be 5389@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
d03bb653 5390running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
a1ba8475
LC
5391
5392@example
e49951eb 5393guix package --list-available
a1ba8475
LC
5394@end example
5395
35ed9306 5396Our goal has been to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
401c53c4
LC
5397Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
5398tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
5399tools that help users exert that freedom.
5400
3ca2731c 5401Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
c320011d
LC
5402
5403@table @code
5404
5405@item x86_64-linux
5406Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
5407
5408@item i686-linux
5409Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
5410
aa1e1947 5411@item armhf-linux
aa725117 5412ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
aa1e1947
MW
5413using the EABI hard-float ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel.
5414
c320011d
LC
5415@item mips64el-linux
5416little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
5417n32 application binary interface (ABI), and Linux-Libre kernel.
5418
5419@end table
5420
4705641f 5421GuixSD itself is currently only available on @code{i686} and @code{x86_64}.
3ca2731c 5422
c320011d
LC
5423@noindent
5424For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
5425@xref{Porting}.
5426
401c53c4 5427@menu
5af6de3e 5428* System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
35ed9306 5429* System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
91ef73d4 5430* Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
05962f29 5431* Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
401c53c4 5432* Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
da7cabd4 5433* Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
401c53c4 5434* Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
8b315a6d 5435* Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
401c53c4
LC
5436@end menu
5437
5438Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
081145cf 5439to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
401c53c4 5440
5af6de3e
LC
5441@node System Installation
5442@section System Installation
5443
3ca2731c
LC
5444@cindex Guix System Distribution
5445This section explains how to install the Guix System Distribution
5446on a machine. The Guix package manager can
35ed9306
LC
5447also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
5448@pxref{Installation}.
5af6de3e
LC
5449
5450@ifinfo
5451@c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
5452@c installation image.
5453You're reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
5454how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
6621cdb6 5455link that follows: @pxref{Help,,, info, Info: An Introduction}. Hit
5af6de3e
LC
5456@kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
5457@end ifinfo
5458
8aaaae38
LC
5459@subsection Limitations
5460
4705641f 5461As of version @value{VERSION}, the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD) is
3ca2731c 5462not production-ready. It may contain bugs and lack important
8aaaae38
LC
5463features. Thus, if you are looking for a stable production system that
5464respects your freedom as a computer user, a good solution at this point
5465is to consider @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-distros.html, one of
5466more established GNU/Linux distributions}. We hope you can soon switch
4705641f 5467to the GuixSD without fear, of course. In the meantime, you can
8aaaae38
LC
5468also keep using your distribution and try out the package manager on top
5469of it (@pxref{Installation}).
5470
5471Before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the following
5472noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
5473
5474@itemize
5475@item
5476The installation process does not include a graphical user interface and
5477requires familiarity with GNU/Linux (see the following subsections to
5478get a feel of what that means.)
5479
5480@item
093ae1be
LC
5481The system does not yet provide full GNOME and KDE desktops. Xfce and
5482Enlightenment are available though, if graphical desktop environments
5483are your thing, as well as a number of X11 window managers.
8aaaae38
LC
5484
5485@item
dbcb0ab1 5486Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
8aaaae38
LC
5487
5488@item
5489Few system services are currently supported out-of-the-box
5490(@pxref{Services}).
5491
5492@item
093ae1be 5493More than 2,000 packages are available, but you may
8aaaae38
LC
5494occasionally find that a useful package is missing.
5495@end itemize
5496
5497You've been warned. But more than a disclaimer, this is an invitation
5498to report issues (and success stories!), and join us in improving it.
5499@xref{Contributing}, for more info.
5af6de3e
LC
5500
5501@subsection USB Stick Installation
5502
5503An installation image for USB sticks can be downloaded from
4705641f 5504@indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz},
5af6de3e
LC
5505where @var{system} is one of:
5506
5507@table @code
5508@item x86_64-linux
5509for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
5510
5511@item i686-linux
5512for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
5513@end table
5514
5515This image contains a single partition with the tools necessary for an
5516installation. It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough
5517USB stick.
5518
5519To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
5520
5521@enumerate
5522@item
5523Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
5524
5525@example
4705641f 5526xz -d guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz
5af6de3e
LC
5527@end example
5528
5529@item
5530Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more in your machine, and determine
5531its device name. Assuming that USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
5532copy the image with:
5533
5534@example
4705641f 5535dd if=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64 of=/dev/sdX
5af6de3e
LC
5536@end example
5537
5538Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
5539@end enumerate
5540
5541Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
5542the USB stick. The latter usually requires you to get in the BIOS' boot
5543menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
5544
5545@subsection Preparing for Installation
5546
5547Once you have successfully booted the image on the USB stick, you should
5548end up with a root prompt. Several console TTYs are configured and can
5549be used to run commands as root. TTY2 shows this documentation,
5550browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Help,,, info, Info: An
ae7ffa9e
LC
5551Introduction}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
5552which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste
5553it with the middle button.
5af6de3e
LC
5554
5555To install the system, you would:
5556
5557@enumerate
5558
5559@item
235cba85
LC
5560Configure the network, by running:
5561
5562@example
5563ifconfig eno1 up && dhclient eno1
5564@end example
5565
5566to get an automatically assigned IP address from the wired
152dd61c 5567network interface controller@footnote{
95c559c1
LC
5568@c http://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
5569The name @code{eno1} is for the first on-board Ethernet controller. The
5570interface name for an Ethernet controller that is in the first slot of
5571the first PCI bus, for instance, would be @code{enp1s0}. Use
235cba85 5572@command{ifconfig -a} to list all the available network interfaces.},
95c559c1 5573or using the @command{ifconfig} command.
5af6de3e
LC
5574
5575The system automatically loads drivers for your network interface
5576controllers.
5577
5578Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
5579image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
5580
5581@item
316d65be
LC
5582Unless this has already been done, you must partition, and then format
5583the target partition.
5af6de3e 5584
7ab44369
LC
5585Preferably, assign partitions a label so that you can easily and
5586reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
5587Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
5588@command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands.
5589
dd816355
LF
5590Be sure that your partition labels match the value of their respective
5591@code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, if your
5592@code{file-system} configuration sets the value of @code{title} to
5593@code{'label}, as do the example configurations found on the USB
5594installation image under @file{/etc/configuration} (@pxref{Using the
5595Configuration System}).
5596
316d65be
LC
5597@c FIXME: Uncomment this once GRUB fully supports encrypted roots.
5598@c A typical command sequence may be:
5599@c
5600@c @example
5601@c # fdisk /dev/sdX
5602@c @dots{} Create partitions etc.@dots{}
5603@c # cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sdX1
5604@c # cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sdX1 my-partition
5605@c # mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
5606@c @end example
6d6e6281 5607
5af6de3e 5608The installation image includes Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU
b419c7f5
LC
5609Parted User Manual}), @command{fdisk}, Cryptsetup/LUKS for disk
5610encryption, and e2fsprogs, the suite of tools to manipulate
5611ext2/ext3/ext4 file systems.
5af6de3e 5612
83a17b62
LC
5613@item
5614Once that is done, mount the target root partition under @file{/mnt}.
5615
5616@item
dd17bc38 5617Lastly, run @code{herd start cow-store /mnt}.
83a17b62
LC
5618
5619This will make @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added
5620to it during the installation phase will be written to the target disk
5621rather than kept in memory.
5622
5af6de3e
LC
5623@end enumerate
5624
5af6de3e
LC
5625
5626@subsection Proceeding with the Installation
5627
5628With the target partitions ready, you now have to edit a file and
5629provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
5630that end, the installation system comes with two text editors: GNU nano
5631(@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), and GNU Zile, an Emacs clone.
5632It is better to store that file on the target root file system, say, as
5633@file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}.
5634
dd51caac
LC
5635@xref{Using the Configuration System}, for examples of operating system
5636configurations. These examples are available under
5637@file{/etc/configuration} in the installation image, so you can copy
5638them and use them as a starting point for your own configuration.
5af6de3e 5639
dd51caac
LC
5640Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
5641be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
5642under @file{/mnt}):
5af6de3e
LC
5643
5644@example
5645guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
5646@end example
5647
5648@noindent
5649This will copy all the necessary files, and install GRUB on
5650@file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-grub} option. For
6621cdb6 5651more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
5af6de3e
LC
5652downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
5653
1bd4e6db
LC
5654Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
5655@command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
5656in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
5657initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
5658unless your configuration specifies otherwise
5659(@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
5660
5661Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
5af6de3e
LC
5662@file{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience---good or not so
5663good.
5664
5665@subsection Building the Installation Image
5666
5667The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
5668system} command, specifically:
5669
5670@example
8a225c66 5671guix system disk-image --image-size=850MiB gnu/system/install.scm
5af6de3e
LC
5672@end example
5673
5674@xref{Invoking guix system}, for more information. See
5675@file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree for more information
5676about the installation image.
5677
cf4a9129
LC
5678@node System Configuration
5679@section System Configuration
b208a005 5680
cf4a9129 5681@cindex system configuration
3ca2731c 5682The Guix System Distribution supports a consistent whole-system configuration
cf4a9129
LC
5683mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
5684configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
5685locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
5686a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
91ef73d4 5687
cf4a9129
LC
5688One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
5689control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
5690makes it possible to roll-back to a previous system instantiation,
5691should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
5692one is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
5693across different machines, or at different points in time, without
5694having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
5695the system's own tools.
5696@c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
91ef73d4 5697
cf4a9129
LC
5698This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
5699administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
5700instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
5701instance to support new system services.
91ef73d4 5702
cf4a9129
LC
5703@menu
5704* Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
7313a52e 5705* operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
cf4a9129 5706* File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
510f9d86 5707* Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
cf4a9129 5708* User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
598e19dc 5709* Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
cf4a9129 5710* Services:: Specifying system services.
0ae8c15a 5711* Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
efb5e833 5712* X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
996ed739 5713* Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
fd1b1fa2 5714* Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
88faf933 5715* GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
cf4a9129 5716* Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
97d76250 5717* Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
cf4a9129
LC
5718* Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
5719@end menu
91ef73d4 5720
cf4a9129
LC
5721@node Using the Configuration System
5722@subsection Using the Configuration System
64d76fa6 5723
cf4a9129
LC
5724The operating system is configured by providing an
5725@code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
5726the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
5727simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
5728kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
91ef73d4 5729
cf4a9129
LC
5730@findex operating-system
5731@lisp
dd51caac 5732@include os-config-bare-bones.texi
cf4a9129 5733@end lisp
401c53c4 5734
cf4a9129
LC
5735This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
5736above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
5737Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
5738which case they get a default value.
e7f34eb0 5739
5d94ac51
LC
5740Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
5741(@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
5742fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
5743@command{guix system}.
5744
5745@unnumberedsubsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
5746
cf4a9129 5747@vindex %base-packages
5d94ac51
LC
5748The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
5749on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
5750environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
5751(@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @var{%base-packages} variable
5752provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
5753tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
5754the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
5755etc. The example above adds tcpdump to those, taken from the @code{(gnu
5756packages admin)} module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
e7f34eb0 5757
f6c9fb1b
LC
5758@findex specification->package
5759Referring to packages by variable name, like @var{tcpdump} above, has
5760the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
5761diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
5762needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
5763@code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
5764the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
5765module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
5766version:
5767
5768@lisp
5769(use-modules (gnu packages))
5770
5771(operating-system
5772 ;; ...
5773 (packages (append (map specification->package
5774 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg-2.0"))
5775 %base-packages)))
5776@end lisp
5777
5d94ac51
LC
5778@unnumberedsubsubsec System Services
5779
cf4a9129
LC
5780@vindex %base-services
5781The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
5782available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
5783The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
5784addition to the basic services, we want the @command{lshd} secure shell
cd6f6c22
LC
5785daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
5786@code{lsh-service}}). Under the hood,
cf4a9129
LC
5787@code{lsh-service} arranges so that @code{lshd} is started with the
5788right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
cd6f6c22
LC
5789generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
5790
5791@cindex customization, of services
5792@findex modify-services
5793Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
5794customize them. For instance, to change the configuration of
5795@code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty (the console log-in), you may write the
5796following instead of @var{%base-services}:
5797
5798@lisp
5799(modify-services %base-services
5800 (guix-service-type config =>
5801 (guix-configuration
5802 (inherit config)
5803 (use-substitutes? #f)
5804 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-outputs"))))
5805 (mingetty-service-type config =>
5806 (mingetty-configuration
5807 (inherit config)
5808 (motd (plain-file "motd" "Hi there!")))))
5809@end lisp
5810
5811@noindent
5812The effect here is to change the options passed to @command{guix-daemon}
5813when it is started, as well as the ``message of the day'' that appears
5814when logging in at the console. @xref{Service Reference,
5815@code{modify-services}}, for more on that.
a1ba8475 5816
dd51caac 5817The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with the X11 display
cd6f6c22 5818server, a desktop environment, network management, power management, and
dd51caac
LC
5819more, would look like this:
5820
5821@lisp
5822@include os-config-desktop.texi
5823@end lisp
5824
5825@xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
efb5e833
LC
5826@var{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
5827information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
dd51caac 5828
5d94ac51
LC
5829Again, @var{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
5830you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
5831procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
5832Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
5833following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
5834@var{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
5835
5836@example
5837(remove (lambda (service)
5838 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
5839 %desktop-services)
5840@end example
5841
5842@unnumberedsubsubsec Instantiating the System
5843
5844Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
5845is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
cf4a9129
LC
5846file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
5847instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
65797bff
LC
5848entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
5849
5850The normal way to change the system's configuration is by updating this
5851file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
5852have to touch files in @command{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
5853system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
5854fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
5855but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
5856system, should you ever need to.
5857
5858@cindex roll-back, of the operating system
5859Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
5860reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
5861modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
5862an entry in the GRUB boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
5863something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
5864@command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
5865generations available on disk.
b81e1947 5866
5d94ac51
LC
5867@unnumberedsubsubsec The Programming Interface
5868
cf4a9129
LC
5869At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
5870is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
5871Monad}):
b81e1947 5872
cf4a9129
LC
5873@deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
5874Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
5875object (@pxref{Derivations}).
b81e1947 5876
cf4a9129
LC
5877The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
5878the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
5879instantiate @var{os}.
5880@end deffn
b81e1947 5881
5d94ac51
LC
5882This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
5883with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
5884guts of GuixSD. Make sure to visit it!
5885
5886
7313a52e
LC
5887@node operating-system Reference
5888@subsection @code{operating-system} Reference
5889
5890This section summarizes all the options available in
5891@code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
5892System}).
5893
5894@deftp {Data Type} operating-system
5895This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
5896By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
5897configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
5898
5899@table @asis
5900@item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
fbb25e56 5901The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
7313a52e
LC
5902only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
5903possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
5904
ee2a6304
LC
5905@item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'()})
5906List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
5907the kernel's command-line---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
5908
7313a52e 5909@item @code{bootloader}
88faf933 5910The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{GRUB Configuration}.
7313a52e
LC
5911
5912@item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
5913A two-argument monadic procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for
5914the Linux kernel. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
5915
f34c56be
LC
5916@item @code{firmware} (default: @var{%base-firmware})
5917@cindex firmware
5918List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
5919
5920The default includes firmware needed for Atheros-based WiFi devices
5921(Linux-libre module @code{ath9k}.)
5922
7313a52e
LC
5923@item @code{host-name}
5924The host name.
5925
5926@item @code{hosts-file}
5927@cindex hosts file
24e02c28 5928A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
7313a52e 5929@file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
24e02c28 5930Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
7313a52e
LC
5931@code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
5932
5933@item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
5934A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
5935
5936@item @code{file-systems}
5937A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
5938
5939@item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
5940@cindex swap devices
5941A list of strings identifying devices to be used for ``swap space''
5942(@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
5943For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")}.
5944
bf87f38a 5945@item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
7313a52e
LC
5946@itemx @code{groups} (default: @var{%base-groups})
5947List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
5948
5949@item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
5950A monadic list of pairs of target file name and files. These are the
5951files that will be used as skeletons as new accounts are created.
5952
5953For instance, a valid value may look like this:
5954
5955@example
5956(mlet %store-monad ((bashrc (text-file "bashrc" "\
5957 export PATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/bin")))
5958 (return `((".bashrc" ,bashrc))))
5959@end example
5960
5961@item @code{issue} (default: @var{%default-issue})
5962A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
5963what displayed when users log in on a text console.
5964
5965@item @code{packages} (default: @var{%base-packages})
5966The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
5967at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
5968
5969The default set includes core utilities, but it is good practice to
5970install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
5971package}).
5972
5973@item @code{timezone}
5974A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
5975
598e19dc
LC
5976@item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
5977The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
5978Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
5979
5980@item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @var{%default-locale-definitions})
5981The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
5982run time. @xref{Locales}.
7313a52e 5983
34760ae7
LC
5984@item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
5985The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
5986to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
5987considerations that justify this option.
5988
996ed739
LC
5989@item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @var{%default-nss})
5990Configuration of libc's name service switch (NSS)---a
5991@code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
5992details.
5993
7313a52e 5994@item @code{services} (default: @var{%base-services})
28d939af 5995A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
7313a52e
LC
5996
5997@item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
5998@cindex PAM
5999@cindex pluggable authentication modules
6000Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
6001@c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
6002
6003@item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
6004List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
6005@xref{Setuid Programs}.
6006
f5a9ffa0
AK
6007@item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
6008@cindex sudoers file
84765839
LC
6009The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
6010(@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
7313a52e
LC
6011
6012This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
6013they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
6014is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
6015@code{sudo}.
6016
6017@end table
6018@end deftp
6019
cf4a9129
LC
6020@node File Systems
6021@subsection File Systems
b81e1947 6022
cf4a9129
LC
6023The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
6024@code{file-systems} field of the operating system's declaration
6025(@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
6026using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
b81e1947
LC
6027
6028@example
cf4a9129
LC
6029(file-system
6030 (mount-point "/home")
6031 (device "/dev/sda3")
6032 (type "ext4"))
b81e1947
LC
6033@end example
6034
cf4a9129
LC
6035As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
6036above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
b81e1947 6037
cf4a9129
LC
6038@deftp {Data Type} file-system
6039Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
6040contain the following members:
5ff3c4b8 6041
cf4a9129
LC
6042@table @asis
6043@item @code{type}
6044This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
6045@code{"ext4"}.
5ff3c4b8 6046
cf4a9129
LC
6047@item @code{mount-point}
6048This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
b81e1947 6049
cf4a9129
LC
6050@item @code{device}
6051This names the ``source'' of the file system. By default it is the name
6052of a node under @file{/dev}, but its meaning depends on the @code{title}
6053field described below.
401c53c4 6054
cf4a9129
LC
6055@item @code{title} (default: @code{'device})
6056This is a symbol that specifies how the @code{device} field is to be
6057interpreted.
401c53c4 6058
cf4a9129
LC
6059When it is the symbol @code{device}, then the @code{device} field is
6060interpreted as a file name; when it is @code{label}, then @code{device}
6061is interpreted as a partition label name; when it is @code{uuid},
6062@code{device} is interpreted as a partition unique identifier (UUID).
da7cabd4 6063
661a1d79
LC
6064UUIDs may be converted from their string representation (as shown by the
6065@command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form, like this:
6066
6067@example
6068(file-system
6069 (mount-point "/home")
6070 (type "ext4")
6071 (title 'uuid)
6072 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
6073@end example
6074
cf4a9129 6075The @code{label} and @code{uuid} options offer a way to refer to disk
661a1d79
LC
6076partitions without having to hard-code their actual device
6077name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
6078@file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
6079result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
6080by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
6081mounted.}.
da7cabd4 6082
5f86a66e
LC
6083However, when a file system's source is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
6084Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
6085device name---e.g., @file{/dev/mapper/root-partition}---and consequently
6086@code{title} must be set to @code{'device}. This is required so that
6087the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
6088corresponding device mapping established.
6089
cf4a9129
LC
6090@item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
6091This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
2c071ce9
LC
6092include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
6093access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
6094bits), and @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution.)
da7cabd4 6095
cf4a9129
LC
6096@item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
6097This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options.
da7cabd4 6098
be21979d
LC
6099@item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
6100This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
6101the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
6102an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
6103is not automatically mounted.
6104
cf4a9129
LC
6105@item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
6106This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
6107booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
6108initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
6109instance, for the root file system.
da7cabd4 6110
cf4a9129
LC
6111@item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
6112This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
6113errors before being mounted.
f9cc8971 6114
4e469051
LC
6115@item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
6116When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
6117
e51710d1
LC
6118@item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
6119This is a list of @code{<file-system>} objects representing file systems
6120that must be mounted before (and unmounted after) this one.
6121
6122As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
6123a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
6124@file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
6125
cf4a9129
LC
6126@end table
6127@end deftp
da7cabd4 6128
a69576ea
LC
6129The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
6130variables.
6131
6132@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
6133These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
cc0e575a 6134such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
3392ce5d
LC
6135below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
6136these.
a69576ea
LC
6137@end defvr
6138
7f239fd3
LC
6139@defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
6140This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
6141@dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
6142functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
6143Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
6144@command{xterm}.
6145@end defvr
6146
db17ae5c
LC
6147@defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
6148This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
6149memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
6150@code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6151@end defvr
6152
3392ce5d
LC
6153@defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
6154This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
6155@file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
6156@code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
6157running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
6158
6159The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
6160read-write in its own ``name space.''
6161@end defvr
6162
a69576ea
LC
6163@defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
6164The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
6165executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
6166@code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
6167@end defvr
6168
6169@defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
6170The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
6171and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
6172@code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
6173@end defvr
6174
510f9d86
LC
6175@node Mapped Devices
6176@subsection Mapped Devices
6177
6178@cindex device mapping
6179@cindex mapped devices
6180The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
6181such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
6182with additional processing over the data that flows through
6183it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
6184concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
6185to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
6186operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
6187devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
6188(@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
6189typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
6190device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
6191
6192Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form:
6193
6194@example
6195(mapped-device
6196 (source "/dev/sda3")
6197 (target "home")
6198 (type luks-device-mapping))
6199@end example
6200
6201@noindent
6202@cindex disk encryption
6203@cindex LUKS
6204This example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
6205@file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
6206@url{http://code.google.com/p/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
6207standard mechanism for disk encryption. The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
6208device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
6209declaration (@pxref{File Systems}). The @code{mapped-device} form is
6210detailed below.
6211
6212@deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
6213Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
6214the system boots up.
6215
9cb426b8
LC
6216@table @code
6217@item source
510f9d86
LC
6218This string specifies the name of the block device to be mapped, such as
6219@code{"/dev/sda3"}.
6220
9cb426b8 6221@item target
510f9d86
LC
6222This string specifies the name of the mapping to be established. For
6223example, specifying @code{"my-partition"} will lead to the creation of
6224the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
6225
9cb426b8 6226@item type
510f9d86
LC
6227This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
6228@var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
6229@end table
6230@end deftp
6231
6232@defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
6233This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
6234command, from the same-named package. This relies on the
6235@code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
6236@end defvr
6237
cf4a9129
LC
6238@node User Accounts
6239@subsection User Accounts
ee85f3db 6240
9bea87a5
LC
6241User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
6242@code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
6243@code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
ee85f3db 6244
cf4a9129
LC
6245@example
6246(user-account
6247 (name "alice")
6248 (group "users")
24e752c0
LC
6249 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
6250 "audio" ;sound card
6251 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
6252 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
cf4a9129
LC
6253 (comment "Bob's sister")
6254 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
6255@end example
25083588 6256
9bea87a5
LC
6257When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
6258the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
6259the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
6260properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
6261directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
6262reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
6263as declared.
6264
cf4a9129
LC
6265@deftp {Data Type} user-account
6266Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
6267be specified:
ee85f3db 6268
cf4a9129
LC
6269@table @asis
6270@item @code{name}
6271The name of the user account.
ee85f3db 6272
cf4a9129
LC
6273@item @code{group}
6274This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
6275this account belongs to.
ee85f3db 6276
cf4a9129
LC
6277@item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
6278Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
6279account belongs to.
ee85f3db 6280
cf4a9129
LC
6281@item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
6282This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
6283latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
6284account is created.
ee85f3db 6285
cf4a9129
LC
6286@item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
6287A comment about the account, such as the account's owner full name.
c8c871d1 6288
cf4a9129
LC
6289@item @code{home-directory}
6290This is the name of the home directory for the account.
ee85f3db 6291
cf4a9129
LC
6292@item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
6293This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
6294the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
ee85f3db 6295
cf4a9129
LC
6296@item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
6297This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
6298account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
6299graphical login managers do not list them.
ee85f3db 6300
1bd4e6db 6301@anchor{user-account-password}
cf4a9129 6302@item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
eb59595c
LC
6303You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
6304passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
9bea87a5
LC
6305users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
6306@command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
6307reconfiguration.
eb59595c
LC
6308
6309If you @emph{do} want to have a preset password for an account, then
6310this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string.
5d1f1177
LC
6311@xref{crypt,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for more information
6312on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
eb59595c 6313Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
c8c871d1 6314
cf4a9129
LC
6315@end table
6316@end deftp
ee85f3db 6317
cf4a9129 6318User group declarations are even simpler:
ee85f3db 6319
cf4a9129
LC
6320@example
6321(user-group (name "students"))
6322@end example
ee85f3db 6323
cf4a9129
LC
6324@deftp {Data Type} user-group
6325This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
af8a56b8 6326
cf4a9129
LC
6327@table @asis
6328@item @code{name}
6329The group's name.
ee85f3db 6330
cf4a9129
LC
6331@item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
6332The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
6333automatically allocated when the group is created.
ee85f3db 6334
c8fa3426
LC
6335@item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
6336This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
6337System groups have low numerical IDs.
6338
cf4a9129
LC
6339@item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
6340What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
6341@code{#f}, this field specifies the group's password.
ee85f3db 6342
cf4a9129
LC
6343@end table
6344@end deftp
401c53c4 6345
cf4a9129
LC
6346For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
6347expect:
401c53c4 6348
cf4a9129
LC
6349@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
6350This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
6351to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
6352``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
6353specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
6354@end defvr
401c53c4 6355
bf87f38a
LC
6356@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
6357This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
6358find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
6359
6360Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
6361special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
6362@end defvr
6363
598e19dc
LC
6364@node Locales
6365@subsection Locales
6366
6367@cindex locale
6368A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
6369and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
6370Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
b2636518 6371@code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
598e19dc
LC
6372@code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
6373cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
6374
6375@cindex locale definition
6376Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
6377using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
6378(@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
6379
6380That locale must be among the @dfn{locale definitions} that are known to
6381the system---and these are specified in the @code{locale-definitions}
6382slot of @code{operating-system}. The default value includes locale
c4847f49 6383definitions for some widely used locales, but not for all the available
598e19dc
LC
6384locales, in order to save space.
6385
6386If the locale specified in the @code{locale} field is not among the
6387definitions listed in @code{locale-definitions}, @command{guix system}
6388raises an error. In that case, you should add the locale definition to
6389the @code{locale-definitions} field. For instance, to add the North
6390Frisian locale for Germany, the value of that field may be:
6391
6392@example
6393(cons (locale-definition
6394 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
6395 %default-locale-definitions)
6396@end example
6397
6398Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
6399list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
6400
6401@example
6402(list (locale-definition
6403 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
6404 (charset "EUC-JP")))
6405@end example
6406
5c3c1427
LC
6407@vindex LOCPATH
6408The compiled locale definitions are available at
46bd6edd
LC
6409@file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
6410version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
6411by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
6412@code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
5c3c1427
LC
6413@code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
6414
598e19dc
LC
6415The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
6416locale)} module. Details are given below.
6417
6418@deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
6419This is the data type of a locale definition.
6420
6421@table @asis
6422
6423@item @code{name}
6424The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
6425Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
6426
6427@item @code{source}
6428The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
6429@code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
6430
6431@item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
6432The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
6433@uref{http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
6434IANA}.
6435
6436@end table
6437@end deftp
6438
6439@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
b2636518
LC
6440An arbitrary list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
6441value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
598e19dc 6442declarations.
b2636518
LC
6443
6444@cindex locale name
6445@cindex normalized codeset in locale names
6446These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
6447that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
6448normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
6449instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
6450@code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
598e19dc 6451@end defvr
401c53c4 6452
34760ae7
LC
6453@subsubsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
6454
6455@cindex incompatibility, of locale data
6456@code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
6457to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
6458declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
6459care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
6460locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
6461another.
6462
6463@c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
6464@c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
6465For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
6466read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
6467@emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
6468data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
6469the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
6470Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
6471all, the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
6472data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
6473programs will not abort.
6474
6475The ``problem'' in GuixSD is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
6476choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
6477be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
6478used to build the system-wide locale data.
6479
6480Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
6481and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
6482@code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
6483
6484Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
6485@file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
6486actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
6487it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
6488administrator can specify several libc packages in the
6489@code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
6490
6491@example
6492(use-package-modules base)
6493
6494(operating-system
6495 ;; @dots{}
6496 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
6497@end example
6498
6499This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
6500both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
6501@file{/run/current-system/locale}.
6502
6503
cf4a9129
LC
6504@node Services
6505@subsection Services
401c53c4 6506
cf4a9129
LC
6507@cindex system services
6508An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
6509listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
6510Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
6511when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
d8b94dbd
LC
6512configuring network access.
6513
dd17bc38
AK
6514Services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd (@pxref{Introduction,,,
6515shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). On a running system, the
6516@command{herd} command allows you to list the available services, show
6517their status, start and stop them, or do other specific operations
6518(@pxref{Jump Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
d8b94dbd
LC
6519
6520@example
dd17bc38 6521# herd status
d8b94dbd
LC
6522@end example
6523
6524The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
dd17bc38 6525services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
d8b94dbd
LC
6526service:
6527
6528@example
dd17bc38 6529# herd doc nscd
d8b94dbd
LC
6530Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
6531@end example
6532
6533The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
6534have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
6535the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
6536
6537@example
dd17bc38 6538# herd stop nscd
d8b94dbd 6539Service nscd has been stopped.
dd17bc38 6540# herd restart xorg-server
d8b94dbd
LC
6541Service xorg-server has been stopped.
6542Service xorg-server has been started.
6543@end example
401c53c4 6544
cf4a9129 6545The following sections document the available services, starting with
d8b94dbd
LC
6546the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
6547declaration.
401c53c4 6548
cf4a9129
LC
6549@menu
6550* Base Services:: Essential system services.
6551* Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
6552* X Window:: Graphical display.
fe1a39d3 6553* Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
105369a4 6554* Database Services:: SQL databases.
d8c18af8 6555* Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
58724c48 6556* Web Services:: Web servers.
aa4ed923 6557* Various Services:: Other services.
cf4a9129 6558@end menu
401c53c4 6559
cf4a9129
LC
6560@node Base Services
6561@subsubsection Base Services
a1ba8475 6562
cf4a9129
LC
6563The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
6564services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
6565this module are listed below.
401c53c4 6566
cf4a9129 6567@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
31771497
LC
6568This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
6569and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
cf4a9129
LC
6570expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
6571libc's name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
6572more.
401c53c4 6573
cf4a9129
LC
6574This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
6575@code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
6576system, you will want to append services to @var{%base-services}, like
6577this:
401c53c4 6578
cf4a9129 6579@example
fa1e31b8 6580(cons* (avahi-service) (lsh-service) %base-services)
cf4a9129
LC
6581@end example
6582@end defvr
401c53c4 6583
be1c2c54 6584@deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
cf4a9129
LC
6585Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
6586@end deffn
401c53c4 6587
66e4f01c
LC
6588@deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
6589Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
6590@code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
6591other things.
cf4a9129 6592@end deffn
401c53c4 6593
66e4f01c
LC
6594@deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
6595This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
6596implements console log-in.
6597
6598@table @asis
6599
6600@item @code{tty}
6601The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
6602
6603@item @code{motd}
6604A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
6605
6606@item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
6607When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
f9b9a033 6608which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
66e4f01c
LC
6609user name and password must be entered to log in.
6610
6611@item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
6612This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
6613is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
6614the name of the log-in program.
6615
6616@item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
6617When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
6618will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
6619
6620@item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
6621The Mingetty package to use.
6622
6623@end table
6624@end deftp
6625
6454b333
LC
6626@cindex name service cache daemon
6627@cindex nscd
be1c2c54 6628@deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
4aee6e60 6629 [#:name-services '()]
b893f1ae
LC
6630Return a service that runs libc's name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
6631given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
6632Service Switch}, for an example.
cf4a9129 6633@end deffn
401c53c4 6634
6454b333
LC
6635@defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
6636This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
6637by @code{nscd-service}. This uses the caches defined by
6638@var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
6639@end defvr
6640
6641@deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
6642This is the type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
6643configuration.
6644
6645@table @asis
6646
b893f1ae
LC
6647@item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
6648List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
6649the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
6650
6651@item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
6652Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
6653command.
6654
6454b333
LC
6655@item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
6656Name of nscd's log file. This is where debugging output goes when
6657@code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
6658
6659@item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
6660Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean more
6661debugging output is logged.
6662
6663@item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
6664List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
6665below.
6666
6667@end table
6668@end deftp
6669
6670@deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
6671Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
6672
6673@table @asis
6674
6675@item @code{database}
6676This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
6677Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
6678@code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
6679(@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6680
6681@item @code{positive-time-to-live}
6682@itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
6683A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
6684negative lookup result remains in cache.
6685
6686@item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
6687Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
6688@var{database}.
6689
6690For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
6691instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
6692them into account.
6693
6694@item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
6695Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
6696
6697@item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
6698Whether the cache should be shared among users.
6699
6700@item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
6701Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
6702
6703@c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
6704@c settings, so leave them out.
6705
6706@end table
6707@end deftp
6708
6709@defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
6710List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
6711@code{nscd-configuration} (see above.)
6712
6713It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
6714lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
6715resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
6716privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
6717external name servers do not even need to be queried.
6718@end defvr
6719
6720
be1c2c54 6721@deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service [#:config-file #f]
1bb76f75
AK
6722Return a service that runs @code{syslogd}. If configuration file name
6723@var{config-file} is not specified, use some reasonable default
cf4a9129
LC
6724settings.
6725@end deffn
401c53c4 6726
0adfe95a
LC
6727@anchor{guix-configuration-type}
6728@deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
6729This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
6730@xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
6731
6732@table @asis
6733@item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
6734The Guix package to use.
401c53c4 6735
0adfe95a
LC
6736@item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
6737Name of the group for build user accounts.
401c53c4 6738
0adfe95a
LC
6739@item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
6740Number of build user accounts to create.
401c53c4 6741
0adfe95a
LC
6742@item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
6743Whether to authorize the substitute key for @code{hydra.gnu.org}
6744(@pxref{Substitutes}).
6745
6746@item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
6747Whether to use substitutes.
6748
b0b9f6e0
LC
6749@item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @var{%default-substitute-urls})
6750The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
6751
0adfe95a
LC
6752@item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
6753List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
6754
6755@item @code{lsof} (default: @var{lsof})
6756@itemx @code{lsh} (default: @var{lsh})
6757The lsof and lsh packages to use.
6758
6759@end table
6760@end deftp
6761
6762@deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-service @var{config}
6763Return a service that runs the Guix build daemon according to
6764@var{config}.
cf4a9129 6765@end deffn
a1ba8475 6766
be1c2c54 6767@deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev udev]
cf4a9129
LC
6768Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
6769@end deffn
401c53c4 6770
be1c2c54 6771@deffn {Scheme Procedure} console-keymap-service @var{file}
5eca9459
AK
6772Return a service to load console keymap from @var{file} using
6773@command{loadkeys} command.
6774@end deffn
6775
8664cc88
LC
6776@deffn {Scheme Procedure} gpm-service-type [#:gpm @var{gpm}] @
6777 [#:options]
6778Run @var{gpm}, the general-purpose mouse daemon, with the given
6779command-line @var{options}. GPM allows users to use the mouse in the console,
6780notably to select, copy, and paste text. The default value of @var{options}
6781uses the @code{ps2} protocol, which works for both USB and PS/2 mice.
6782
6783This service is not part of @var{%base-services}.
6784@end deffn
6785
1c52181f
LC
6786@anchor{guix-publish-service}
6787@deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-publish-service [#:guix @var{guix}] @
6788 [#:port 80] [#:host "localhost"]
6789Return a service that runs @command{guix publish} listening on @var{host}
6790and @var{port} (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
6791
6792This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
6793created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
6794archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
6795@end deffn
6796
a69576ea 6797
cf4a9129
LC
6798@node Networking Services
6799@subsubsection Networking Services
401c53c4 6800
fa1e31b8 6801The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
cf4a9129 6802the network interface.
a1ba8475 6803
a023cca8 6804@cindex DHCP, networking service
be1c2c54 6805@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcp-client-service [#:dhcp @var{isc-dhcp}]
a023cca8
LC
6806Return a service that runs @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
6807Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces.
6808@end deffn
6809
be1c2c54 6810@deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
cf4a9129
LC
6811 [#:gateway #f] [#:name-services @code{'()}]
6812Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
6813@var{gateway} is true, it must be a string specifying the default network
6814gateway.
6815@end deffn
8b315a6d 6816
b7d0c494 6817@cindex wicd
87f40011 6818@cindex network management
be1c2c54 6819@deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
87f40011
LC
6820Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
6821management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
6822
6823This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
6824several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
6825@command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
6826and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
b7d0c494
MW
6827@end deffn
6828
c0a9589d
SB
6829@cindex NetworkManager
6830@deffn {Scheme Procedure} network-manager-service @
6831 [#:network-manager @var{network-manager}]
6832Return a service that runs NetworkManager, a network connection manager
6833that attempting to keep active network connectivity when available.
6834@end deffn
6835
be1c2c54 6836@deffn {Scheme Procedure} ntp-service [#:ntp @var{ntp}] @
63854bcb
LC
6837 [#:name-service @var{%ntp-servers}]
6838Return a service that runs the daemon from @var{ntp}, the
6839@uref{http://www.ntp.org, Network Time Protocol package}. The daemon will
6840keep the system clock synchronized with that of @var{servers}.
6841@end deffn
6842
6843@defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
6844List of host names used as the default NTP servers.
6845@end defvr
6846
375c6108
LC
6847@deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-service [@var{config-file}] [#:tor @var{tor}]
6848Return a service to run the @uref{https://torproject.org, Tor} anonymous
6849networking daemon.
8b315a6d 6850
375c6108 6851The daemon runs as the @code{tor} unprivileged user. It is passed
6331bde7
LC
6852@var{config-file}, a file-like object, with an additional @code{User tor} line
6853and lines for hidden services added via @code{tor-hidden-service}. Run
6854@command{man tor} for information about the configuration file.
6855@end deffn
6856
24a8ef3b 6857@cindex hidden service
6331bde7
LC
6858@deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
6859Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
6860@var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
6861
6862@example
24a8ef3b
LC
6863 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
6864 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
6331bde7
LC
6865@end example
6866
6867In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
6868port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
6869
6629099a
LC
6870This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
6871the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
6331bde7
LC
6872service.
6873
6874See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
6875project's documentation} for more information.
cf4a9129 6876@end deffn
8b315a6d 6877
be1c2c54 6878@deffn {Scheme Procedure} bitlbee-service [#:bitlbee bitlbee] @
4627a464
LC
6879 [#:interface "127.0.0.1"] [#:port 6667] @
6880 [#:extra-settings ""]
6881Return a service that runs @url{http://bitlbee.org,BitlBee}, a daemon that
6882acts as a gateway between IRC and chat networks.
6883
6884The daemon will listen to the interface corresponding to the IP address
6885specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}. @code{127.0.0.1} means that only
6886local clients can connect, whereas @code{0.0.0.0} means that connections can
6887come from any networking interface.
6888
6889In addition, @var{extra-settings} specifies a string to append to the
6890configuration file.
6891@end deffn
6892
f4391bec 6893Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following service.
8b315a6d 6894
be1c2c54 6895@deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
5833bf33 6896 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
cf4a9129
LC
6897 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
6898 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
6899 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
21cc905a 6900 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
cf4a9129
LC
6901Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
6902@var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
6903only by root.
72e25e35 6904
5833bf33
DP
6905When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
6906controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
6907@var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
6908depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
6909@command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
6910
cf4a9129
LC
6911When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
6912upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
6913require interaction.
8b315a6d 6914
20dd519c
LC
6915When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
6916randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
6917a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
6918basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
6919
cf4a9129
LC
6920When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
6921network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
6922or addresses.
9bf3c1a7 6923
20dd519c
LC
6924@var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
6925passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
cf4a9129 6926root.
4af2447e 6927
cf4a9129
LC
6928The other options should be self-descriptive.
6929@end deffn
4af2447e 6930
fa0c1d61
LC
6931@defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
6932This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
6933(@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
6934line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
6935on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
6936host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
6937
6938This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
7313a52e
LC
6939@code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
6940@file{/etc/hosts}}):
fa0c1d61
LC
6941
6942@example
6943(use-modules (gnu) (guix))
6944
6945(operating-system
6946 (host-name "mymachine")
6947 ;; ...
6948 (hosts-file
6949 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
6950 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
24e02c28
LC
6951 (plain-file "hosts"
6952 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
6953 %facebook-host-aliases))))
fa0c1d61
LC
6954@end example
6955
6956This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
6957browsers, from accessing Facebook.
6958@end defvr
6959
965a7332
LC
6960The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
6961
be1c2c54 6962@deffn {Scheme Procedure} avahi-service [#:avahi @var{avahi}] @
965a7332
LC
6963 [#:host-name #f] [#:publish? #t] [#:ipv4? #t] @
6964 [#:ipv6? #t] [#:wide-area? #f] @
6965 [#:domains-to-browse '()]
6966Return a service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
6967mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
cc9c1f39
LC
6968"zero-configuration" host name lookups (see @uref{http://avahi.org/}), and
6969extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can resolve
6970@code{.local} host names using
1065bed9
LC
6971@uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. Additionally,
6972add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that commands such as
6973@command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
965a7332
LC
6974
6975If @var{host-name} is different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
6976publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
6977
6978When @var{publish?} is true, publishing of host names and services is allowed;
6979in particular, avahi-daemon will publish the machine's host name and IP
6980address via mDNS on the local network.
6981
6982When @var{wide-area?} is true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
6983
6984Boolean values @var{ipv4?} and @var{ipv6?} determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6
6985sockets.
6986@end deffn
6987
6988
cf4a9129
LC
6989@node X Window
6990@subsubsection X Window
68ad877c 6991
cf4a9129
LC
6992Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
6993Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
6994there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
6995started by the @dfn{login manager}, currently SLiM.
4af2447e 6996
be1c2c54 6997@deffn {Scheme Procedure} slim-service [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] @
0ecc3bf3
LC
6998 [#:auto-login? #f] [#:default-user ""] [#:startx] @
6999 [#:theme @var{%default-slim-theme}] @
4bd43bbe 7000 [#:theme-name @var{%default-slim-theme-name}]
cf4a9129
LC
7001Return a service that spawns the SLiM graphical login manager, which in
7002turn starts the X display server with @var{startx}, a command as returned by
7003@code{xorg-start-command}.
4af2447e 7004
04e4e6ab
LC
7005@cindex X session
7006
7007SLiM automatically looks for session types described by the @file{.desktop}
7008files in @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users
7009to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. Packages such as
7010@var{xfce}, @var{sawfish}, and @var{ratpoison} provide @file{.desktop} files;
7011adding them to the system-wide set of packages automatically makes them
7012available at the log-in screen.
7013
7014In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
7015@file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
7016and/or other X clients.
7017
cf4a9129
LC
7018When @var{allow-empty-passwords?} is true, allow logins with an empty
7019password. When @var{auto-login?} is true, log in automatically as
7020@var{default-user}.
0ecc3bf3
LC
7021
7022If @var{theme} is @code{#f}, the use the default log-in theme; otherwise
7023@var{theme} must be a gexp denoting the name of a directory containing the
7024theme to use. In that case, @var{theme-name} specifies the name of the
7025theme.
cf4a9129 7026@end deffn
4af2447e 7027
0ecc3bf3
LC
7028@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
7029@defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
7030The G-Expression denoting the default SLiM theme and its name.
7031@end defvr
7032
be1c2c54 7033@deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [#:guile] @
d1cdd7ba 7034 [#:configuration-file #f] [#:xorg-server @var{xorg-server}]
f703413e 7035Return a derivation that builds a @var{guile} script to start the X server
d1cdd7ba
LC
7036from @var{xorg-server}. @var{configuration-file} is the server configuration
7037file or a derivation that builds it; when omitted, the result of
7038@code{xorg-configuration-file} is used.
7039
7040Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
7041@end deffn
7042
be1c2c54 7043@deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-configuration-file @
12422c9d 7044 [#:drivers '()] [#:resolutions '()] [#:extra-config '()]
d1cdd7ba
LC
7045Return a configuration file for the Xorg server containing search paths for
7046all the common drivers.
f703413e
LC
7047
7048@var{drivers} must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a
7049graphics driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in
d1cdd7ba 7050this order---e.g., @code{(\"modesetting\" \"vesa\")}.
d2e59637
LC
7051
7052Likewise, when @var{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an
7053appropriate screen resolution; otherwise, it must be a list of
7054resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024 768) (640 480))}.
12422c9d
LC
7055
7056Last, @var{extra-config} is a list of strings or objects appended to the
7057@code{text-file*} argument list. It is used to pass extra text to be added
7058verbatim to the configuration file.
f703413e 7059@end deffn
4af2447e 7060
6726282b
LC
7061@deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{name}]
7062Add @var{package}, a package for a screen-locker or screen-saver whose
7063command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
7064for it. For example:
7065
7066@lisp
7067(screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
7068@end lisp
7069
7070makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
7071@end deffn
7072
7073
fe1a39d3
LC
7074@node Desktop Services
7075@subsubsection Desktop Services
aa4ed923 7076
fe1a39d3
LC
7077The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
7078usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
7079machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
7080interfaces, etc.
aa4ed923 7081
4467be21
LC
7082To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
7083services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
7084environment and networking:
7085
7086@defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
7087This is a list of services that builds upon @var{%base-services} and
7088adds or adjust services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
7089
7090In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
6726282b
LC
7091@code{slim-service}}), screen lockers,
7092a network management tool (@pxref{Networking
4467be21 7093Services, @code{wicd-service}}), energy and color management services,
4650a77e 7094the @code{elogind} login and seat manager, the Polkit privilege service,
cee32ee4
AW
7095the GeoClue location service, an NTP client (@pxref{Networking
7096Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the name service switch service
7097configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns} (@pxref{Name Service
7098Switch, mDNS}).
4467be21
LC
7099@end defvr
7100
7101The @var{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
7102field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
7103Reference, @code{services}}).
7104
0adfe95a
LC
7105The actual service definitions provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)}
7106and @code{(gnu services desktop)} are described below.
4467be21 7107
0adfe95a 7108@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
fe1a39d3
LC
7109Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
7110support for @var{services}.
aa4ed923 7111
fe1a39d3
LC
7112@uref{http://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
7113facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
7114and be notified of system-wide events.
aa4ed923 7115
fe1a39d3
LC
7116@var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
7117@file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
7118and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
7119@var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
aa4ed923
AK
7120@end deffn
7121
0adfe95a 7122@deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
4650a77e
AW
7123Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
7124seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/andywingo/elogind,
7125Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
7126are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
7127system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
7128
7129Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
7130example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
7131when the power button is pressed.
7132
7133The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
7134elogind, and should be the result of a @code{(elogind-configuration
7135(@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
7136their default values are:
7137
7138@table @code
7139@item kill-user-processes?
7140@code{#f}
7141@item kill-only-users
7142@code{()}
7143@item kill-exclude-users
7144@code{("root")}
7145@item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
7146@code{5}
7147@item handle-power-key
7148@code{poweroff}
7149@item handle-suspend-key
7150@code{suspend}
7151@item handle-hibernate-key
7152@code{hibernate}
7153@item handle-lid-switch
7154@code{suspend}
7155@item handle-lid-switch-docked
7156@code{ignore}
7157@item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
7158@code{#f}
7159@item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
7160@code{#f}
7161@item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
7162@code{#f}
7163@item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
7164@code{#t}
7165@item holdoff-timeout-seconds
7166@code{30}
7167@item idle-action
7168@code{ignore}
7169@item idle-action-seconds
7170@code{(* 30 60)}
7171@item runtime-directory-size-percent
7172@code{10}
7173@item runtime-directory-size
7174@code{#f}
7175@item remove-ipc?
7176@code{#t}
7177@item suspend-state
7178@code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
7179@item suspend-mode
7180@code{()}
7181@item hibernate-state
7182@code{("disk")}
7183@item hibernate-mode
7184@code{("platform" "shutdown")}
7185@item hybrid-sleep-state
7186@code{("disk")}
7187@item hybrid-sleep-mode
7188@code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
7189@end table
7190@end deffn
7191
be1c2c54 7192@deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
4650a77e 7193 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
222e3319
LC
7194Return a service that runs the
7195@uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
7196management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
7197privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
7198privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
7199capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
7200the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
4650a77e
AW
7201@end deffn
7202
be1c2c54 7203@deffn {Scheme Procedure} upower-service [#:upower @var{upower}] @
be234128
AW
7204 [#:watts-up-pro? #f] @
7205 [#:poll-batteries? #t] @
7206 [#:ignore-lid? #f] @
7207 [#:use-percentage-for-policy? #f] @
7208 [#:percentage-low 10] @
7209 [#:percentage-critical 3] @
7210 [#:percentage-action 2] @
7211 [#:time-low 1200] @
7212 [#:time-critical 300] @
7213 [#:time-action 120] @
7214 [#:critical-power-action 'hybrid-sleep]
7215Return a service that runs @uref{http://upower.freedesktop.org/,
7216@command{upowerd}}, a system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery
7217levels, with the given configuration settings. It implements the
7218@code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is notably used by
7219GNOME.
7220@end deffn
7221
2b9e0a94
LC
7222@deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
7223Return a service for @uref{http://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
7224UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
7225notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
7226include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
7227@end deffn
7228
be1c2c54 7229@deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
7ce597ff
AW
7230Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
7231interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
7232screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
7233tool. See @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
7234site} for more information.
7235@end deffn
7236
cee32ee4
AW
7237@deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
7238Return an configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
7239location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
7240the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
7241will have access to location information by default. The boolean
7242@var{system?} value indicates that an application is a system component
7243or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
7244this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
7245means that all users are allowed.
7246@end deffn
7247
7248@defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
7249The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
7250granting authority to GNOME's date-and-time utility to ask for the
7251current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the Firefox
7252(IceCat) and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
7253Firefox and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
7254know the user's location.
7255@end defvr
7256
be1c2c54 7257@deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
cee32ee4
AW
7258 [#:whitelist '()] @
7259 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
7260 [#:submit-data? #f]
7261 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
7262 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
7263 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
7264Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
7265provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
7266user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
7267location databases. See
7268@uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
7269web site} for more information.
7270@end deffn
7271
105369a4
DT
7272@node Database Services
7273@subsubsection Database Services
7274
7275The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following service.
7276
be1c2c54 7277@deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
105369a4
DT
7278 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data'']
7279Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
7280server.
7281
7282The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from
7283@var{config-file} and stores the database cluster in
7284@var{data-directory}.
7285@end deffn
fe1a39d3 7286
d8c18af8
AW
7287@node Mail Services
7288@subsubsection Mail Services
7289
7290The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
7291for mail services. Currently the only implemented service is Dovecot,
7292an IMAP, POP3, and LMTP server.
7293
7294Guix does not yet have a mail transfer agent (MTA), although for some
7295lightweight purposes the @code{esmtp} relay-only MTA may suffice. Help
7296is needed to properly integrate a full MTA, such as Postfix. Patches
7297welcome!
7298
7299To add an IMAP/POP3 server to a GuixSD system, add a
7300@code{dovecot-service} to the operating system definition:
7301
7302@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
7303Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
7304@end deffn
7305
7306By default, Dovecot doesn't need much configuration; the default
7307configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
7308suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
7309certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
7310Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
7311number of options though which mail administrators might need to change,
7312and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
7313administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
7314
7315For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
7316one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
7317
7318@example
7319(dovecot-service #:config
7320 (dovecot-configuration
7321 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
7322@end example
7323
7324The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
7325definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
7326indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
7327strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
7328if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
7329from some other system; see the end for more details.
7330
7331@c The following documentation was initially generated by
7332@c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
7333@c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
7334@c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
7335@c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
7336@c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
7337@c the churn as dovecot updates.
7338
7339Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
7340
7341@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
7342The dovecot package.
7343@end deftypevr
7344
7345@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
7346A list of IPs or hosts where to listen in for connections. @samp{*}
7347listens in all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens in all IPv6
7348interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
7349complex, customize the address and port fields of the
7350@samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
7351@end deftypevr
7352
7353@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
7354List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
7355@samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
7356
7357Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
7358
7359@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
7360The name of the protocol.
7361@end deftypevr
7362
7363@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
7364UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
7365This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
7366Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
7367@end deftypevr
7368
7369@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
7370Space separated list of plugins to load.
7371@end deftypevr
7372
7373@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
7374Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
7375address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
7376Defaults to @samp{10}.
7377@end deftypevr
7378
7379@end deftypevr
7380
7381@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
7382List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
7383@samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
7384@samp{lmtp}.
7385
7386Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
7387
7388@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
7389The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
7390@code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
7391@code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
7392@code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
7393@end deftypevr
7394
7395@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
7396Listeners for the service. A listener is either an
7397@code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
7398an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
7399Defaults to @samp{()}.
7400
7401Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
7402
7403@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
7404The file name on which to listen.
7405@end deftypevr
7406
7407@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
7408The access mode for the socket.
7409Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
7410@end deftypevr
7411
7412@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
f9b9a033 7413The user to own the socket.
d8c18af8
AW
7414Defaults to @samp{""}.
7415@end deftypevr
7416
7417@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
7418The group to own the socket.
7419Defaults to @samp{""}.
7420@end deftypevr
7421
7422
7423Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
7424
7425@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
7426The file name on which to listen.
7427@end deftypevr
7428
7429@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
7430The access mode for the socket.
7431Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
7432@end deftypevr
7433
7434@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
f9b9a033 7435The user to own the socket.
d8c18af8
AW
7436Defaults to @samp{""}.
7437@end deftypevr
7438
7439@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
7440The group to own the socket.
7441Defaults to @samp{""}.
7442@end deftypevr
7443
7444
7445Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
7446
7447@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
7448The protocol to listen for.
7449@end deftypevr
7450
7451@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
7452The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
7453Defaults to @samp{""}.
7454@end deftypevr
7455
7456@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
7457The port on which to listen.
7458@end deftypevr
7459
7460@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
7461Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
7462@samp{required}.
7463Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7464@end deftypevr
7465
7466@end deftypevr
7467
7468@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
7469Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
7470Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
7471secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
7472Defaults to @samp{1}.
7473@end deftypevr
7474
7475@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
7476Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
7477Defaults to @samp{0}.
7478@end deftypevr
7479
7480@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
7481If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
7482this.
7483Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
7484@end deftypevr
7485
7486@end deftypevr
7487
7488@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
7489Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
7490constructor.
7491
7492Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
7493
7494@deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
7495A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
7496Defaults to @samp{()}.
7497@end deftypevr
7498
7499@end deftypevr
7500
7501@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
7502List of passdb configurations, each one created by the
7503@code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
7504
7505Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
7506
7507@deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
7508The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
7509@samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
7510@samp{static}.
7511Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
7512@end deftypevr
7513
7514@deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
7515A list of key-value args to the passdb driver.
7516Defaults to @samp{()}.
7517@end deftypevr
7518
7519@end deftypevr
7520
7521@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
7522List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
7523@code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
7524
7525Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
7526
7527@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
7528The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
7529@samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
7530Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
7531@end deftypevr
7532
7533@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
7534A list of key-value args to the userdb driver.
7535Defaults to @samp{()}.
7536@end deftypevr
7537
7538@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
7539Override fields from passwd.
7540Defaults to @samp{()}.
7541@end deftypevr
7542
7543@end deftypevr
7544
7545@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
7546Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
7547constructor.
7548@end deftypevr
7549
7550@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
7551List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
7552@code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
7553
7554Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
7555
7556@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
7557Name for this namespace.
7558@end deftypevr
7559
7560@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
7561Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
7562Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
7563@end deftypevr
7564
7565@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
7566Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
7567all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
7568one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
7569format.
7570Defaults to @samp{""}.
7571@end deftypevr
7572
7573@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
7574Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
7575different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
7576Defaults to @samp{""}.
7577@end deftypevr
7578
7579@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
7580Physical location of the mailbox. This is in same format as
7581mail_location, which is also the default for it.
7582Defaults to @samp{""}.
7583@end deftypevr
7584
7585@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
7586There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
7587namespace has it.
7588Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7589@end deftypevr
7590
7591@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
7592If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
7593extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
7594useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
7595which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
7596create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
7597and @samp{mail/}.
7598Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7599@end deftypevr
7600
7601@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
7602Show the mailboxes under this namespace with LIST command. This
7603makes the namespace visible for clients that don't support NAMESPACE
7604extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
7605hides the namespace prefix.
7606Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7607@end deftypevr
7608
7609@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
7610Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
7611parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
7612as @code{#t}.)
7613Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7614@end deftypevr
7615
7616@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
7617List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
7618Defaults to @samp{()}.
7619
7620Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
7621
7622@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
7623Name for this mailbox.
7624@end deftypevr
7625
7626@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
7627@samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
7628@samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
7629Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
7630@end deftypevr
7631
7632@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
7633List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
7634Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
7635@code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
7636Defaults to @samp{()}.
7637@end deftypevr
7638
7639@end deftypevr
7640
7641@end deftypevr
7642
7643@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
7644Base directory where to store runtime data.
7645Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
7646@end deftypevr
7647
7648@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
7649Greeting message for clients.
7650Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
7651@end deftypevr
7652
7653@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
7654List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
7655allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
7656authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
7657for these networks. Typically you'd specify your IMAP proxy servers
7658here.
7659Defaults to @samp{()}.
7660@end deftypevr
7661
7662@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
7663List of login access check sockets (e.g. tcpwrap).
7664Defaults to @samp{()}.
7665@end deftypevr
7666
7667@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
7668Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
7669and IP address. Useful for seeing who are actually using the IMAP
7670processes (e.g. shared mailboxes or if same uid is used for multiple
7671accounts).
7672Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7673@end deftypevr
7674
7675@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
7676Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
7677Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
7678forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
7679be a problem if the upgrade is e.g. because of a security fix).
7680Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7681@end deftypevr
7682
7683@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
7684If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
7685server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
7686Defaults to @samp{0}.
7687@end deftypevr
7688
7689@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
7690UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
7691Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
7692@end deftypevr
7693
7694@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
7695List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
7696and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
7697key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
7698@end deftypevr
7699
7700@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
7701Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
7702SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
7703matches the local IP (i.e. you're connecting from the same computer),
7704the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
7705allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
7706Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7707@end deftypevr
7708
7709@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
7710Authentication cache size (e.g. @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
7711Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
7712for caching to be used.
7713Defaults to @samp{0}.
7714@end deftypevr
7715
7716@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
7717Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
7718is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
7719failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
7720user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
7721cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
7722authentication.
7723Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
7724@end deftypevr
7725
7726@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
7727TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
77280 disables caching them completely.
7729Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
7730@end deftypevr
7731
7732@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
7733List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
7734You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
7735Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
7736realm first.
7737Defaults to @samp{()}.
7738@end deftypevr
7739
7740@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
7741Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
7742both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
7743logins.
7744Defaults to @samp{""}.
7745@end deftypevr
7746
7747@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
7748List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
7749contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
7750This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
7751potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
7752you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
7753Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
7754@end deftypevr
7755
7756@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
7757Username character translations before it's looked up from
7758databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
7759example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
7760translated to @samp{@@}.
7761Defaults to @samp{""}.
7762@end deftypevr
7763
7764@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
7765Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
7766use the standard variables here, e.g. %Lu would lowercase the username,
7767%n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
7768change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
7769@samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
7770Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
7771@end deftypevr
7772
7773@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
7774If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
7775username within the normal username string (i.e. not using SASL
7776mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
7777here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
7778UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
7779choice.
7780Defaults to @samp{""}.
7781@end deftypevr
7782
7783@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
7784Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
7785mechanism.
7786Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
7787@end deftypevr
7788
7789@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
7790Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
7791execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g. MySQL and PAM).
7792They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
7793Defaults to @samp{30}.
7794@end deftypevr
7795
7796@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
7797Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
7798the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
7799allow all keytab entries.
7800Defaults to @samp{""}.
7801@end deftypevr
7802
7803@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
7804Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
7805system default (usually /etc/krb5.keytab) if not specified. You may
7806need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
7807file.
7808Defaults to @samp{""}.
7809@end deftypevr
7810
7811@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
7812Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
7813and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
7814<doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
7815Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7816@end deftypevr
7817
7818@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
7819Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
7820Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
7821@end deftypevr
7822
7823@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
7824Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
7825Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
7826@end deftypevr
7827
7828@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
7829Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
7830fails.
7831Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7832@end deftypevr
7833
7834@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
7835Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
7836@code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
7837CommonName.
7838Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7839@end deftypevr
7840
7841@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
7842List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
7843@samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
7844@samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
7845@samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
7846@samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
7847@end deftypevr
7848
7849@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
7850List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
7851Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
7852director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
7853Defaults to @samp{()}.
7854@end deftypevr
7855
7856@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
7857List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
7858allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
7859Defaults to @samp{()}.
7860@end deftypevr
7861
7862@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
7863How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
7864has any connections.
7865Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
7866@end deftypevr
7867
7868@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer director-doveadm-port
7869TCP/IP port that accepts doveadm connections (instead of director
7870connections) If you enable this, you'll also need to add
7871@samp{inet-listener} for the port.
7872Defaults to @samp{0}.
7873@end deftypevr
7874
7875@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
7876How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
7877include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
7878are shared within domain.
7879Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
7880@end deftypevr
7881
7882@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
7883Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
7884@samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
7885Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
7886@end deftypevr
7887
7888@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
7889Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
7890@samp{log-path}.
7891Defaults to @samp{""}.
7892@end deftypevr
7893
7894@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
7895Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
7896@samp{info-log-path}.
7897Defaults to @samp{""}.
7898@end deftypevr
7899
7900@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
7901Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
7902don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
7903standard facilities are supported.
7904Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
7905@end deftypevr
7906
7907@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
7908Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
7909failed.
7910Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7911@end deftypevr
7912
7913@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose-passwords?
7914In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
7915values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
7916force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
7917and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
7918":n" (e.g. sha1:6).
7919Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7920@end deftypevr
7921
7922@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
7923Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
7924SQL queries.
7925Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7926@end deftypevr
7927
7928@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
7929In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
7930the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
7931@samp{auth-debug}.
7932Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7933@end deftypevr
7934
7935@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
7936Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
7937Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
7938Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7939@end deftypevr
7940
7941@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
7942Show protocol level SSL errors.
7943Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7944@end deftypevr
7945
7946@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
7947Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
7948strftime(3) format.
7949Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
7950@end deftypevr
7951
7952@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
7953List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
7954non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
7955string.
7956@end deftypevr
7957
7958@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
7959Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
7960string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
7961Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
7962@end deftypevr
7963
7964@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
7965Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
7966of possible variables you can use.
7967Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u): \""}.
7968@end deftypevr
7969
7970@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
7971Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
7972@table @code
7973@item %$
7974Delivery status message (e.g. @samp{saved to INBOX})
7975@item %m
7976Message-ID
7977@item %s
7978Subject
7979@item %f
7980From address
7981@item %p
7982Physical size
7983@item %w
7984Virtual size.
7985@end table
7986Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
7987@end deftypevr
7988
7989@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
7990Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
7991that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
7992if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
7993Dovecot the full location.
7994
7995If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
7996file (e.g. /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
7997where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
7998directory", and it must be the first path given in the
7999@samp{mail-location} setting.
8000
8001There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
8002
8003@table @samp
8004@item %u
8005username
8006@item %n
8007user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
8008@item %d
8009domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
8010@item %h
8011home director
8012@end table
8013
8014See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
8015@table @samp
8016@item maildir:~/Maildir
8017@item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
8018@item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
8019@end table
8020Defaults to @samp{""}.
8021@end deftypevr
8022
8023@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
8024System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
8025userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
8026either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
8027Defaults to @samp{""}.
8028@end deftypevr
8029
8030@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
8031
8032Defaults to @samp{""}.
8033@end deftypevr
8034
8035@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
8036Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
8037this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
8038dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
8039/var/mail.
8040Defaults to @samp{""}.
8041@end deftypevr
8042
8043@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
8044Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
8045Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
8046that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
8047symlinks (e.g. if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
8048could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
8049/secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
8050Defaults to @samp{""}.
8051@end deftypevr
8052
8053@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
8054Allow full filesystem access to clients. There's no access checks
8055other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
8056works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
8057names with e.g. /path/ or ~user/.
8058Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8059@end deftypevr
8060
8061@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
8062Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
8063shared filesystems (NFS or clustered filesystem).
8064Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8065@end deftypevr
8066
8067@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
8068Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
8069supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
8070nowadays by default.
8071Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8072@end deftypevr
8073
8074@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
8075When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
8076@table @code
8077@item optimized
8078Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
8079@item always
8080Useful with e.g. NFS when write()s are delayed
8081@item never
8082Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
8083@end table
8084Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
8085@end deftypevr
8086
8087@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
8088Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
8089NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
8090this isn't needed.
8091Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8092@end deftypevr
8093
8094@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
8095Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
8096@samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
8097Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8098@end deftypevr
8099
8100@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
8101Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
8102dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
8103than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
8104change @samp{mmap-disable}.
8105Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
8106@end deftypevr
8107
8108@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
8109Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
8110kB.
8111Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
8112@end deftypevr
8113
8114@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
8115Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
8116log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
8117hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
8118is set to 0.
8119Defaults to @samp{500}.
8120@end deftypevr
8121
8122@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
8123
8124Defaults to @samp{0}.
8125@end deftypevr
8126
8127@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
8128Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
8129aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
8130non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
8131Defaults to @samp{1}.
8132@end deftypevr
8133
8134@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
8135
8136Defaults to @samp{0}.
8137@end deftypevr
8138
8139@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
8140Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
8141trying to create new keywords.
8142Defaults to @samp{50}.
8143@end deftypevr
8144
8145@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
8146List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
8147processes (i.e. /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
8148too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
8149@samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
8150"/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
8151which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
8152this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
8153<doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
8154Defaults to @samp{()}.
8155@end deftypevr
8156
8157@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
8158Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
8159for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
8160directory (e.g. /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
8161there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
8162access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
8163directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/." to
8164@samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
8165Defaults to @samp{""}.
8166@end deftypevr
8167
8168@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
8169UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
8170This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
8171Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
8172@end deftypevr
8173
8174@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
8175Directory where to look up mail plugins.
8176Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
8177@end deftypevr
8178
8179@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
8180List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
8181LDA, etc. are added to this list in their own .conf files.
8182Defaults to @samp{()}.
8183@end deftypevr
8184
8185@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
8186The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
8187cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
8188writes at the cost of more disk reads.
8189Defaults to @samp{0}.
8190@end deftypevr
8191
8192@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
8193When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
8194see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
8195the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
8196dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
8197occur.
8198Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
8199@end deftypevr
8200
8201@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
8202Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
8203mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
8204FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
8205slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
8206they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
8207Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8208@end deftypevr
8209
8210@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
8211By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
8212with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
8213which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
8214causes more disk I/O.
8215 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
8216and it's done always regardless of this setting).
8217Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8218@end deftypevr
8219
8220@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
8221When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
8222This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
8223side effects.
8224Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8225@end deftypevr
8226
8227@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
8228Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
8229directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
8230the mail otherwise.
8231Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8232@end deftypevr
8233
8234@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
8235Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
8236available:
8237
8238@table @code
8239@item dotlock
8240Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
8241solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
8242need write access to that directory.
8243@item dotlock-try
8244Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
8245isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
8246@item fcntl
8247Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
8248@item flock
8249May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
8250@item lockf
8251May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
8252@end table
8253
8254You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
8255in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
8256locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
8257them simultaneously.
8258@end deftypevr
8259
8260@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
8261
8262@end deftypevr
8263
8264@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
8265Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
8266Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
8267@end deftypevr
8268
8269@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
8270If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
8271override the lock file after this much time.
8272Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
8273@end deftypevr
8274
8275@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
8276When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
8277what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
8278the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
8279simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
8280this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
8281whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
8282downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
8283flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
8284done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
8285Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8286@end deftypevr
8287
8288@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
8289Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
8290EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
8291@samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
8292Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8293@end deftypevr
8294
8295@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
8296Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
8297and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
8298useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
8299that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
8300Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8301@end deftypevr
8302
8303@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
8304If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g. 100k), don't write index
8305files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
8306updated.
8307Defaults to @samp{0}.
8308@end deftypevr
8309
8310@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
8311Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
8312Defaults to @samp{2000000}.
8313@end deftypevr
8314
8315@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
8316Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
8317begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
8318disabled.
8319Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
8320@end deftypevr
8321
8322@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
8323When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
8324@samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
8325with some filesystems (ext4, xfs).
8326Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8327@end deftypevr
8328
8329@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
8330sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
8331which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
8332don't support this for now.
8333
8334WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
8335
8336Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
8337Defaults to @samp{""}.
8338@end deftypevr
8339
8340@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
8341Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
8342possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
8343externally.
8344Defaults to @samp{128000}.
8345@end deftypevr
8346
8347@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
8348Filesystem backend to use for saving attachments:
8349@table @code
8350@item posix
8351No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
8352@item sis posix
8353SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
8354@item sis-queue posix
8355SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
8356@end table
8357Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
8358@end deftypevr
8359
8360@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
8361Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
8362variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
8363@code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
8364truncated, e.g. @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
8365Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
8366@end deftypevr
8367
8368@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
8369
8370Defaults to @samp{100}.
8371@end deftypevr
8372
8373@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
8374
8375Defaults to @samp{1000}.
8376@end deftypevr
8377
8378@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
8379Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
8380This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
8381before they eat up everything.
8382Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
8383@end deftypevr
8384
8385@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
8386Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
8387untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
8388at all.
8389Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
8390@end deftypevr
8391
8392@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
8393Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
8394separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
8395processes.
8396Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
8397@end deftypevr
8398
8399@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
8400SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
8401Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
8402@end deftypevr
8403
8404@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
8405PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
8406Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
8407@end deftypevr
8408
8409@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
8410PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
8411dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
8412root.
8413Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
8414@end deftypevr
8415
8416@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
8417If key file is password protected, give the password here.
8418Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
8419this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
8420instead to a different.
8421Defaults to @samp{""}.
8422@end deftypevr
8423
8424@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
8425PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
8426intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
8427contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
8428CRL(s). (e.g. @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
8429Defaults to @samp{""}.
8430@end deftypevr
8431
8432@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
8433Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
8434Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8435@end deftypevr
8436
8437@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
8438Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
8439it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
8440Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8441@end deftypevr
8442
8443@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
8444Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
8445x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
8446@samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
8447Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
8448@end deftypevr
8449
8450@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} hours ssl-parameters-regenerate
8451How often to regenerate the SSL parameters file. Generation is
8452quite CPU intensive operation. The value is in hours, 0 disables
8453regeneration entirely.
8454Defaults to @samp{168}.
8455@end deftypevr
8456
8457@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-protocols
8458SSL protocols to use.
8459Defaults to @samp{"!SSLv2"}.
8460@end deftypevr
8461
8462@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
8463SSL ciphers to use.
8464Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!LOW:!SSLv2:!EXP:!aNULL"}.
8465@end deftypevr
8466
8467@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
8468SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
8469Defaults to @samp{""}.
8470@end deftypevr
8471
8472@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
8473Address to use when sending rejection mails.
8474Default is postmaster@@<your domain>. %d expands to recipient domain.
8475Defaults to @samp{""}.
8476@end deftypevr
8477
8478@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
8479Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g. in Message-Id)
8480and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
8481Defaults to @samp{""}.
8482@end deftypevr
8483
8484@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
8485If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
8486bouncing the mail.
8487Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8488@end deftypevr
8489
8490@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
8491Binary to use for sending mails.
8492Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
8493@end deftypevr
8494
8495@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
8496If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
8497sendmail.
8498Defaults to @samp{""}.
8499@end deftypevr
8500
8501@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
8502Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
8503variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
8504Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
8505@end deftypevr
8506
8507@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
8508Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
8509variables:
8510
8511@table @code
8512@item %n
8513CRLF
8514@item %r
8515reason
8516@item %s
8517original subject
8518@item %t
8519recipient
8520@end table
8521Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
8522@end deftypevr
8523
8524@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
8525Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
8526address.
8527Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
8528@end deftypevr
8529
8530@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
8531Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
8532address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
8533parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
8534X-Original-To.
8535Defaults to @samp{""}.
8536@end deftypevr
8537
8538@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
8539Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
8540it?.
8541Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8542@end deftypevr
8543
8544@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
8545Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
8546subscribed?.
8547Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8548@end deftypevr
8549
8550@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
8551Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
8552command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
8553get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
8554often.
8555Defaults to @samp{64000}.
8556@end deftypevr
8557
8558@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
8559IMAP logout format string:
8560@table @code
8561@item %i
8562total number of bytes read from client
8563@item %o
8564total number of bytes sent to client.
8565@end table
8566Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o"}.
8567@end deftypevr
8568
8569@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
8570Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
8571add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g. +XFOO XBAR).
8572Defaults to @samp{""}.
8573@end deftypevr
8574
8575@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
8576How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
8577is IDLEing.
8578Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
8579@end deftypevr
8580
8581@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
8582ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
8583makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
8584values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
8585support-email.
8586Defaults to @samp{""}.
8587@end deftypevr
8588
8589@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
8590ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
8591Defaults to @samp{""}.
8592@end deftypevr
8593
8594@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
8595Workarounds for various client bugs:
8596
8597@table @code
8598@item delay-newmail
8599Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
8600CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
8601Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
8602may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
8603still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
8604"Headers Only".
8605
8606@item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
8607Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
8608adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
8609ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
8610
8611@item tb-lsub-flags
8612Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g. mbox).
8613This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
8614greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
8615@end table
8616Defaults to @samp{()}.
8617@end deftypevr
8618
8619@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
8620Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
8621Defaults to @samp{""}.
8622@end deftypevr
8623
8624
8625Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
8626that GuixSD has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
8627language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
8628but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
8629inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
8630
8631However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
8632and running. In that case, you can pass an
8633@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} paramter to
8634@code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
8635does not have easy reflective capabilities.
8636
8637Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
8638
8639@deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
8640The dovecot package.
8641@end deftypevr
8642
8643@deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
8644The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
8645@end deftypevr
8646
8647For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
8648could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
8649
8650@example
8651(dovecot-service #:config
8652 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
8653 (string "")))
8654@end example
8655
58724c48
DT
8656@node Web Services
8657@subsubsection Web Services
8658
8659The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the following service:
8660
be1c2c54 8661@deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-service [#:nginx nginx] @
58724c48
DT
8662 [#:log-directory ``/var/log/nginx''] @
8663 [#:run-directory ``/var/run/nginx''] @
8664 [#:config-file]
8665
8666Return a service that runs @var{nginx}, the nginx web server.
8667
8668The nginx daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file}.
8669Log files are written to @var{log-directory} and temporary runtime data
8670files are written to @var{run-directory}. For proper operation, these
8671arguments should match what is in @var{config-file} to ensure that the
8672directories are created when the service is activated.
8673
8674@end deffn
8675
fe1a39d3
LC
8676@node Various Services
8677@subsubsection Various Services
8678
8679The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
8680
be1c2c54 8681@deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
fe1a39d3
LC
8682 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
8683 [#:extra-options '()]
8684Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
8685decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
8686
8687Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
8688(configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
8689for details.
8690
8691Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
8692passed to @command{lircd}.
8693@end deffn
8694
8695
0ae8c15a
LC
8696@node Setuid Programs
8697@subsection Setuid Programs
8698
8699@cindex setuid programs
8700Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
8701launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
4d40227c
LC
8702@command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
8703password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
0ae8c15a
LC
8704@file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
8705obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
8706@dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
8707(@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
f7e4ae7f 8708for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
0ae8c15a
LC
8709
8710The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
8711security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
8712populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
8713used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
8714the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
8715should be setuid root.
8716
8717The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
8718declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
8719programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
8720For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
8721package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
8722
8723@example
8724#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
8725@end example
8726
8727A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
8728@code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
8729
8730@defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
8731A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
8732
8733The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
8734@command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
8735@end defvr
8736
8737Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
8738@file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
8739files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
8740store.
8741
efb5e833
LC
8742@node X.509 Certificates
8743@subsection X.509 Certificates
8744
8745@cindex HTTPS, certificates
8746@cindex X.509 certificates
8747@cindex TLS
8748Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
8749security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
8750that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
8751that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
8752so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
8753signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
8754
8755Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
8756certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
8757out-of-the-box.
8758
8759However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
8760@command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
8761certificates can be found.
8762
8763@cindex @code{nss-certs}
8764In GuixSD, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
8765to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
8766(@pxref{operating-system Reference}). GuixSD includes one such package,
8767@code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
8768Mozilla's Network Security Services.
8769
8770Note that it is @emph{not} part of @var{%base-packages}, so you need to
8771explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
8772most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
8773to the certificates installed globally.
8774
8775Unprivileged users can also install their own certificate package in
8776their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
8777that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
8778OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
8779variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
8780instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
8781pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable.
8782
8783
996ed739
LC
8784@node Name Service Switch
8785@subsection Name Service Switch
8786
8787@cindex name service switch
8788@cindex NSS
8789The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
8790configuration file of libc's @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
8791(@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
8792Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
8793extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
8794includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
8795Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
8796C Library Reference Manual}).
8797
8798The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
8799method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
8800together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
8801next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
8802@code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
8803(@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
8804
4c9050c6
LC
8805@cindex nss-mdns
8806@cindex .local, host name lookup
996ed739 8807As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
4c9050c6
LC
8808@uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
8809back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
8810for host names ending in @code{.local}:
996ed739
LC
8811
8812@example
8813(name-service-switch
8814 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
8815
8816 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
8817 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
8818 (name-service
8819 (name "mdns_minimal")
8820
8821 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
8822 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
8823 ;; no need to try the next methods.
8824 (reaction (lookup-specification
8825 (not-found => return))))
8826
8827 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
8828 (name-service
8829 (name "dns"))
8830
8831 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
8832 (name-service
8833 (name "mdns")))))
8834@end example
8835
15137a29
LC
8836Don't worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
8837contains this configuration, so you won't have to type it if all you
8838want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
8839
4c9050c6
LC
8840Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
8841@code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
cc9c1f39
LC
8842you also need to use @code{avahi-service} (@pxref{Networking Services,
8843@code{avahi-service}}), or @var{%desktop-services}, which includes it
8844(@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
8845to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
8846@code{nscd-service}}).
15137a29
LC
8847
8848For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
8849configurations.
8850
8851@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
8852This is the default name service switch configuration, a
8853@code{name-service-switch} object.
8854@end defvr
8855
8856@defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
8857This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
8858lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
8859@end defvr
4c9050c6 8860
996ed739
LC
8861The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
8862is a direct mapping of the C library's configuration file format, so
8863please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
8864Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
8865Compared to libc's NSS configuration file format, it has the advantage
8866not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
8867static checks: you'll know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
8868run @command{guix system}.
8869
996ed739
LC
8870@deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
8871
8872This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
8873service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
8874system databases.
8875
8876@table @code
8877@item aliases
8878@itemx ethers
8879@itemx group
8880@itemx gshadow
8881@itemx hosts
8882@itemx initgroups
8883@itemx netgroup
8884@itemx networks
8885@itemx password
8886@itemx public-key
8887@itemx rpc
8888@itemx services
8889@itemx shadow
8890The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
8891list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below.)
8892@end table
8893@end deftp
8894
8895@deftp {Data Type} name-service
8896
8897This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
8898associated lookup action.
8899
8900@table @code
8901@item name
8902A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
8903configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
8904
4aee6e60
LC
8905Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
8906achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
8907@code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
8908services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
8909
996ed739
LC
8910@item reaction
8911An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
8912(@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
8913Reference Manual}). For example:
8914
8915@example
8916(lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
8917 (success => return))
8918@end example
8919@end table
8920@end deftp
0ae8c15a 8921
fd1b1fa2
LC
8922@node Initial RAM Disk
8923@subsection Initial RAM Disk
8924
8925@cindex initial RAM disk (initrd)
8926@cindex initrd (initial RAM disk)
8927For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
8928@dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
8929root file system, as well as an initialization script. The latter is
8930responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
8931kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
8932
8933The @code{initrd} field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
8934you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
8935system linux-initrd)} module provides two ways to build an initrd: the
8936high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure, and the low-level
8937@code{expression->initrd} procedure.
8938
8939The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
8940For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
8941at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
8942system declaration like this:
8943
8944@example
52ac153e 8945(initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
027981d6
LC
8946 ;; Create a standard initrd that has modules "foo.ko"
8947 ;; and "bar.ko", as well as their dependencies, in
8948 ;; addition to the modules available by default.
52ac153e 8949 (apply base-initrd file-systems
027981d6 8950 #:extra-modules '("foo" "bar")
52ac153e 8951 rest)))
fd1b1fa2
LC
8952@end example
8953
52ac153e
LC
8954The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
8955involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system whose
8956root file system is volatile.
fd1b1fa2 8957
e90cf6c1
LC
8958The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} honors several
8959options passed on the Linux kernel command line (that is, arguments
8960passed @i{via} GRUB's @code{linux} command, or with QEMU's
8961@code{-append} option), notably:
8962
8963@table @code
8964@item --load=@var{boot}
8965Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
8966program, once it has mounted the root file system.
8967
8968GuixSD uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
dd17bc38 8969service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
e90cf6c1
LC
8970initialization system.
8971
8972@item --root=@var{root}
8973Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
8974device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a partition label, or a partition
8975UUID.
8976
8977@item --system=@var{system}
8978Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
8979@var{system}.
8980
8981@item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
8982@cindex module, black-listing
8983@cindex black list, of kernel modules
8984Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
8985(from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
8986must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
8987@code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
8988
8989@item --repl
8990Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
8991tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
8992marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
8993love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
8994Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
8995
8996@end table
8997
8998Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
8999@code{base-initrd} provide, here is how to use it and customize it
9000further.
9001
fd1b1fa2 9002@deffn {Monadic Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
9059b97d 9003 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:virtio? #t] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
52ac153e 9004 [#:extra-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()]
fd1b1fa2
LC
9005Return a monadic derivation that builds a generic initrd. @var{file-systems} is
9006a list of file-systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
9007the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
52ac153e
LC
9008@var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
9009@var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
fd1b1fa2
LC
9010
9011When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
9012parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so the initrd can
9013be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
9014
9015When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
9016to it are lost.
9017
9018The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
9019for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. However, additional kernel
9020modules can be listed in @var{extra-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
9021loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
9022@end deffn
9023
9024Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
9025statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
9026program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
9027@code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
9028program to run in that initrd.
9029
9030@deffn {Monadic Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
9031 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"] @
42d10464 9032 [#:modules '()]
fd1b1fa2
LC
9033Return a derivation that builds a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
9034containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
df650fa8
LC
9035upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
9036automatically copied to the initrd.
fd1b1fa2 9037
42d10464
LC
9038@var{modules} is a list of Guile module names to be embedded in the
9039initrd.
fd1b1fa2
LC
9040@end deffn
9041
88faf933
LC
9042@node GRUB Configuration
9043@subsection GRUB Configuration
9044
9045@cindex GRUB
9046@cindex boot loader
9047
9048The operating system uses GNU@tie{}GRUB as its boot loader
9049(@pxref{Overview, overview of GRUB,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). It is
9050configured using @code{grub-configuration} declarations. This data type
9051is exported by the @code{(gnu system grub)} module, and described below.
9052
9053@deftp {Data Type} grub-configuration
9054The type of a GRUB configuration declaration.
9055
9056@table @asis
9057
9058@item @code{device}
9059This is a string denoting the boot device. It must be a device name
9060understood by the @command{grub-install} command, such as
9061@code{/dev/sda} or @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub,
9062GNU GRUB Manual}).
9063
9064@item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
9065A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
9066entries to appear in the GRUB boot menu, in addition to the current
9067system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
9068
9069@item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
9070The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the current
9071system's entry.
9072
9073@item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
9074The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
90750 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
9076
9077@item @code{theme} (default: @var{%default-theme})
9078The @code{grub-theme} object describing the theme to use.
9079@end table
9080
9081@end deftp
9082
9083Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
9084@code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
9085@code{menu-entry} form:
9086
9087@deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
9088The type of an entry in the GRUB boot menu.
9089
9090@table @asis
9091
9092@item @code{label}
35ed9306 9093The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
88faf933
LC
9094
9095@item @code{linux}
9096The Linux kernel to boot.
9097
9098@item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
9099The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
9100@code{("console=ttyS0")}.
9101
9102@item @code{initrd}
9103A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
9104to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
9105
9106@end table
9107@end deftp
9108
9109@c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
9110Themes are created using the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not
9111documented yet.
9112
9113@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
9114This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system, with a
9115fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix logos.
9116@end defvr
9117
9118
cf4a9129
LC
9119@node Invoking guix system
9120@subsection Invoking @code{guix system}
0918e64a 9121
cf4a9129
LC
9122Once you have written an operating system declaration, as seen in the
9123previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
9124system} command. The synopsis is:
4af2447e 9125
cf4a9129
LC
9126@example
9127guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
9128@end example
4af2447e 9129
cf4a9129
LC
9130@var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
9131@code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
9132operating system is instantiate. Currently the following values are
9133supported:
4af2447e 9134
cf4a9129
LC
9135@table @code
9136@item reconfigure
9137Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
9138switch to it@footnote{This action is usable only on systems already
65797bff 9139running GuixSD.}.
4af2447e 9140
cf4a9129
LC
9141This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
9142accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
4af2447e 9143
cf4a9129
LC
9144It also adds a GRUB menu entry for the new OS configuration, and moves
9145entries for older configurations to a submenu---unless
9146@option{--no-grub} is passed.
4af2447e 9147
bf2479c7
LC
9148@c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
9149@c <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
9150It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
9151@command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
9152guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
9153once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
9154
cf4a9129
LC
9155@item build
9156Build the operating system's derivation, which includes all the
9157configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
9158This action does not actually install anything.
113daf62 9159
cf4a9129
LC
9160@item init
9161Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
9162operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
4705641f 9163installations of GuixSD. For instance:
113daf62
LC
9164
9165@example
cf4a9129 9166guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
113daf62
LC
9167@end example
9168
cf4a9129
LC
9169copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
9170specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
9171files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
9172needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
9173@file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
113daf62 9174
cf4a9129
LC
9175This command also installs GRUB on the device specified in
9176@file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-grub} option was passed.
113daf62 9177
cf4a9129
LC
9178@item vm
9179@cindex virtual machine
0276f697 9180@cindex VM
f535dcbe 9181@anchor{guix system vm}
cf4a9129
LC
9182Build a virtual machine that contain the operating system declared in
9183@var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
810568b3 9184Arguments given to the script are passed as is to QEMU.
113daf62 9185
cf4a9129 9186The VM shares its store with the host system.
113daf62 9187
0276f697
LC
9188Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
9189the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
9190specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
9191provides read-only access to the shared directory.
9192
9193The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
9194accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
9195read-write mapping of the host's @file{$HOME/tmp}:
9196
9197@example
9198guix system vm my-config.scm \
9199 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
9200@end example
9201
6aa260af
LC
9202On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
9203the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
9204host's store can then be mounted.
9205
9206The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
9207with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
9208containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
9209be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
9210image's size.
ab11f0be 9211
cf4a9129
LC
9212@item vm-image
9213@itemx disk-image
9214Return a virtual machine or disk image of the operating system declared
9215in @var{file} that stands alone. Use the @option{--image-size} option
9216to specify the size of the image.
113daf62 9217
cf4a9129 9218When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
97d76250
LF
9219the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM},
9220for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
113daf62 9221
cf4a9129
LC
9222When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
9223copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
9224the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image on it
9225using the following command:
113daf62 9226
cf4a9129
LC
9227@example
9228# dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
9229@end example
113daf62 9230
1c8a81b1
DT
9231@item container
9232Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
9233within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
9234mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
9235substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
9236the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
9237host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
9238
9239Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
9240a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
9241system.
9242
9243As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
9244systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
9245using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
9246
9247@example
9248guix system container my-config.scm \
9249 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
9250@end example
9251
0f252e26 9252@quotation Note
cfd35b4e 9253This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
0f252e26
DT
9254@end quotation
9255
cf4a9129 9256@end table
113daf62 9257
cf4a9129
LC
9258@var{options} can contain any of the common build options provided by
9259@command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). In addition,
9260@var{options} can contain one of the following:
113daf62 9261
cf4a9129
LC
9262@table @option
9263@item --system=@var{system}
9264@itemx -s @var{system}
9265Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host's system type.
9266This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
113daf62 9267
f3f427c2
LC
9268@item --derivation
9269@itemx -d
9270Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
9271building anything.
9272
cf4a9129
LC
9273@item --image-size=@var{size}
9274For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
9275of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
4a44d7bb
LC
9276include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
9277coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
db030303
LC
9278
9279@item --on-error=@var{strategy}
9280Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
9281@var{strategy} may be one of the following:
9282
9283@table @code
9284@item nothing-special
9285Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
9286
9287@item backtrace
9288Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
9289
9290@item debug
9291Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
9292commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
9293display local variable values, and more generally inspect the program's
9294state. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
9295a list of available debugging commands.
9296@end table
113daf62 9297@end table
113daf62 9298
cf4a9129
LC
9299Note that all the actions above, except @code{build} and @code{init},
9300rely on KVM support in the Linux-Libre kernel. Specifically, the
9301machine should have hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
9302KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
9303must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the daemon's
9304build users.
8451a568 9305
65797bff
LC
9306Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
9307your GuixSD installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
9308system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
9309GRUB boot menu:
9310
9311@table @code
9312
9313@item list-generations
9314List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
9315disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
9316@option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
9317(@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
9318
9319Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
9320in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
9321generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
9322generations up to 10-day old:
9323
9324@example
9325$ guix system list-generations 10d
9326@end example
9327
9328@end table
9329
d6c3267a
LC
9330The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
9331sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
9332each other:
9333
9334@anchor{system-extension-graph}
9335@table @code
9336
9337@item extension-graph
9338Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
9339extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
9340(@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
9341extensions.)
9342
9343The command:
9344
9345@example
9346$ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
9347@end example
9348
9349produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
9350
6f305ea5
LC
9351@anchor{system-dmd-graph}
9352@item dmd-graph
9353Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
dd17bc38
AK
9354graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
9355@var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
9356example graph.
6f305ea5 9357
d6c3267a
LC
9358@end table
9359
97d76250
LF
9360@node Running GuixSD in a VM
9361@subsection Running GuixSD in a virtual machine
9362
9363One way to run GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) is to build a GuixSD
9364virtual machine image using @command{guix system vm-image}
9365(@pxref{Invoking guix system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format,
9366which the @uref{http://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
9367
9368To run the image in QEMU, copy it out of the store (@pxref{The Store})
9369and give yourself permission to write to the copy. When invoking QEMU,
9370you must choose a system emulator that is suitable for your hardware
9371platform. Here is a minimal QEMU invocation that will boot the result
9372of @command{guix system vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
9373
9374@example
9375$ qemu-system-x86_64 \
9376 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
9377 -enable-kvm -m 256 /tmp/qemu-image
9378@end example
9379
9380Here is what each of these options means:
9381
9382@table @code
9383@item qemu-system-x86_64
9384This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
9385host.
9386
9387@item -net user
9388Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
9389access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
9390guest OS online. If you don't choose a network stack, the boot will
9391fail.
9392
9393@item -net nic,model=virtio
9394You must create a network interface of a given model. If you don't
9395create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
9396x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
9397@command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
9398
9399@item -enable-kvm
9400If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
9401Linux kernel's virtual machine support (KVM) will make things run
9402faster.
9403
9404@item -m 256
9405RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
9406which may be insufficent for some operations.
9407
9408@item /tmp/qemu-image
9409The file name of the qcow2 image.
9410@end table
d6c3267a 9411
cf4a9129
LC
9412@node Defining Services
9413@subsection Defining Services
8451a568 9414
eb524192 9415The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
0adfe95a
LC
9416them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
9417them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
8451a568 9418
0adfe95a
LC
9419@menu
9420* Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
9421* Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
9422* Service Reference:: API reference.
dd17bc38 9423* Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
0adfe95a
LC
9424@end menu
9425
9426@node Service Composition
9427@subsubsection Service Composition
9428
9429@cindex services
9430@cindex daemons
9431Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
9432operating system's functionality. Often a service is a process---a
9433@dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
9434Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
9435whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
9436started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
9437@command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
9438daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
9439and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
9440collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
9441daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the system's @file{/etc}
9442directory.
9443
d6c3267a 9444@cindex service extensions
0adfe95a 9445GuixSD services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
dd17bc38
AK
9446secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---GuixSD's
9447initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
9448lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
9449Services, @code{lsh-service}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
9450service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
9451udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
9452Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
9453Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
9454and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
9455user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
0adfe95a
LC
9456
9457All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
9458acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
9459as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
9460
9461@image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
9462
d62e201c
LC
9463@cindex system service
9464At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
9465directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
9466by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
9467to learn about the other service types shown here.
d6c3267a
LC
9468@xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
9469command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
9470particular operating system definition.
0adfe95a
LC
9471
9472@cindex service types
9473Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
9474relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
9475system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
9476shell server (lsh) has two instances of @var{lsh-service-type}, with
9477different parameters.
9478
9479The following section describes the programming interface for service
9480types and services.
9481
9482@node Service Types and Services
9483@subsubsection Service Types and Services
9484
9485A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
9486with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
9487(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
9488
9489@example
9490(define guix-service-type
9491 (service-type
9492 (name 'guix)
9493 (extensions
d4053c71 9494 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
0adfe95a
LC
9495 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
9496 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))))
9497@end example
8451a568 9498
cf4a9129 9499@noindent
0adfe95a
LC
9500It defines a two things:
9501
9502@enumerate
9503@item
9504A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
9505
9506@item
9507A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
9508target service type and a procedure that, given the service's
9509parameters, returns a list of object to extend the service of that type.
9510
9511Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
9512exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
9513@end enumerate
9514
9515In this example, @var{guix-service-type} extends three services:
9516
9517@table @var
d4053c71
AK
9518@item shepherd-root-service-type
9519The @var{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
9520service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
9521object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
9522(@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
0adfe95a
LC
9523
9524@item account-service-type
9525This extension for this service is computed by @var{guix-accounts},
9526which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
9527objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
9528guix-daemon}).
9529
9530@item activation-service-type
9531Here @var{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
9532a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
9533booted.
9534@end table
9535
9536A service of this type is instantiated like this:
9537
9538@example
9539(service guix-service-type
9540 (guix-configuration
9541 (build-accounts 5)
9542 (use-substitutes? #f)))
9543@end example
9544
9545The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
9546the parameters of this specific service instance.
9547@xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
9548information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type.
9549
9550@var{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
9551services but is not extensible itself.
9552
9553@c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
9554
9555The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
9556
9557@example
9558(define udev-service-type
9559 (service-type (name 'udev)
9560 (extensions
d4053c71
AK
9561 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
9562 udev-shepherd-service)))
0adfe95a
LC
9563
9564 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
9565 (extend (lambda (config rules)
9566 (match config
9567 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
9568 (udev-configuration
9569 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
9570 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
9571@end example
9572
9573This is the service type for the
9574@uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
9575management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
d4053c71 9576extension of @var{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
0adfe95a
LC
9577
9578@table @code
9579@item compose
9580This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
9581services of this type.
9582
9583Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
9584compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
9585
9586@item extend
9587This procedure defines how the service's value is @dfn{extended} with
9588the composition of the extensions.
9589
9590Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
9591value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
9592extend that record by appending the list of rules is contains to the
9593list of contributed rules.
9594@end table
9595
9596There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
9597@var{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
9598@code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
9599
9600Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
9601interface for services.
9602
9603@node Service Reference
9604@subsubsection Service Reference
9605
9606We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
9607Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
9608services and service types. This interface is provided by the
9609@code{(gnu services)} module.
9610
9611@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} @var{value}
9612Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
9613below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
9614this particular service instance.
9615@end deffn
9616
9617@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
9618Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
9619@end deffn
8451a568 9620
0adfe95a
LC
9621@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
9622Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
9623@end deffn
9624
9625@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-parameters @var{service}
9626Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
9627parameters.
9628@end deffn
9629
9630Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
9631
9632@example
9633(define s
9634 (service nginx-service-type
9635 (nginx-configuration
9636 (nginx nginx)
9637 (log-directory log-directory)
9638 (run-directory run-directory)
9639 (file config-file))))
9640
9641(service? s)
9642@result{} #t
9643
9644(eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
9645@result{} #t
9646@end example
9647
cd6f6c22
LC
9648The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
9649parameters of some of the services of a list such as
9650@var{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). Of
9651course, you could always use standard list combinators such as
9652@code{map} and @code{fold} to do that (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,,
9653guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}); @code{modify-services} simply
9654provides a more concise form for this common pattern.
9655
9656@deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
9657 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
9658
9659Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
9660clauses. Each clause has the form:
9661
9662@example
9663(@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
9664@end example
9665
9666where @var{type} is a service type, such as @var{guix-service-type}, and
9667@var{variable} is an identifier that is bound within @var{body} to the
9668value of the service of that @var{type}. @xref{Using the Configuration
9669System}, for an example.
9670
9671This is a shorthand for:
9672
9673@example
9674(map (lambda (service) @dots{}) @var{services})
9675@end example
9676@end deffn
9677
9678Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
9679something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
9680necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
9681@code{operating-system} declaration.
9682
0adfe95a
LC
9683@deftp {Data Type} service-type
9684@cindex service type
9685This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
9686and Services}).
9687
9688@table @asis
9689@item @code{name}
9690This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
9691
9692@item @code{extensions}
9693A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below.)
9694
9695@item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
9696If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
9697be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
9698services.
9699
9700Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
9701by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
9702extensions. It must return a value that is a valid parameter value for
9703the service instance.
9704
9705@item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
9706If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
9707
9708Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
9709calls it, passing it the service's initial value as the first argument
9710and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension values as the
9711second argument.
9712@end table
9713
9714@xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
9715@end deftp
9716
9717@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
9718 @var{compute}
9719Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
9720@var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
9721calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
9722the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
9723@end deffn
9724
9725@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
9726Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
9727@end deffn
9728
9729At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
9730procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
d62e201c
LC
9731down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
9732run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
9733command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
9734service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
9735on the way, until it reaches the root node.
0adfe95a
LC
9736
9737@deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
d62e201c 9738 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
0adfe95a
LC
9739Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
9740type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
9741@end deffn
9742
9743Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
9744service types, some of which are listed below.
9745
d62e201c
LC
9746@defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
9747This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
9748as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
9749@end defvr
9750
0adfe95a 9751@defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
d62e201c
LC
9752The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
9753The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
0adfe95a
LC
9754@end defvr
9755
9756@defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
9757The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service can be extended by
9758passing it name/file tuples such as:
9759
9760@example
9761(list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
9762@end example
9763
9764In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
9765pointing to the given file.
9766@end defvr
9767
9768@defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
9769Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
9770executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
9771setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
9772@end defvr
9773
af4c3fd5
LC
9774@defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
9775Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
9776programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
9777extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
9778@end defvr
9779
0adfe95a 9780
dd17bc38
AK
9781@node Shepherd Services
9782@subsubsection Shepherd Services
0adfe95a
LC
9783
9784@cindex PID 1
9785@cindex init system
0190c1c0
AK
9786The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} provides a way to define services
9787managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is GuixSD initialization
9788system---the first process that is started when the system boots,
9789aka. PID@tie{}1 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
9790Manual}).
6f305ea5 9791
dd17bc38
AK
9792Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
9793SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
9794started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
9795been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
9796the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
6f305ea5
LC
9797
9798@image{images/dmd-graph,,5in,Typical dmd service graph.}
9799
9800You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
9801definition using the @command{guix system dmd-graph} command
9802(@pxref{system-dmd-graph, @command{guix system dmd-graph}}).
9803
d4053c71
AK
9804The @var{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
9805PID@tie{}1, of type @var{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
9806by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
0adfe95a 9807
d4053c71 9808@deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
dd17bc38 9809The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
0adfe95a
LC
9810
9811@table @asis
9812@item @code{provision}
9813This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
9814
dd17bc38
AK
9815These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
9816@command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
9817shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
9818@code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
0adfe95a
LC
9819
9820@item @code{requirements} (default: @code{'()})
dd17bc38 9821List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
0adfe95a
LC
9822
9823@item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
9824Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
9825underlying process dies.
9826
9827@item @code{start}
9828@itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
dd17bc38
AK
9829The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
9830facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
9831Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
9832G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
9833(@pxref{G-Expressions}).
0adfe95a
LC
9834
9835@item @code{documentation}
9836A documentation string, as shown when running:
9837
9838@example
dd17bc38 9839herd doc @var{service-name}
0adfe95a
LC
9840@end example
9841
9842where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @var{provision}
dd17bc38 9843(@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
fae685b9
LC
9844
9845@item @code{modules} (default: @var{%default-modules})
9846This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
9847@code{stop} are evaluated.
9848
9849@item @code{imported-modules} (default: @var{%default-imported-modules})
9850This is the list of modules to import in the execution environment of
dd17bc38 9851the Shepherd.
fae685b9 9852
0adfe95a
LC
9853@end table
9854@end deftp
9855
d4053c71 9856@defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
dd17bc38 9857The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
0adfe95a
LC
9858
9859This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
dd17bc38 9860shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
d4053c71 9861Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
0adfe95a
LC
9862@end defvr
9863
d4053c71 9864@defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
0adfe95a
LC
9865This service represents PID@tie{}1.
9866@end defvr
8451a568 9867
8451a568 9868
cf4a9129
LC
9869@node Installing Debugging Files
9870@section Installing Debugging Files
8451a568 9871
cf4a9129
LC
9872@cindex debugging files
9873Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
9874typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
9875@dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
9876debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
9877debug a compiled program in good conditions.
8451a568 9878
cf4a9129
LC
9879The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
9880of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
9881weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
9882debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
9883Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
9884debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
9885for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
8451a568 9886
cf4a9129
LC
9887Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
9888mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
9889information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
9890files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
9891when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
9892with GDB}).
8451a568 9893
cf4a9129
LC
9894The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
9895information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
9896output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
9897Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
9898of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
9899installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
9900Guile:
8451a568
LC
9901
9902@example
cf4a9129 9903guix package -i glibc:debug guile:debug
8451a568
LC
9904@end example
9905
cf4a9129
LC
9906GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
9907setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
9908from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
9909GDB}):
8451a568 9910
cf4a9129
LC
9911@example
9912(gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
9913@end example
8451a568 9914
cf4a9129
LC
9915From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
9916@code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
8451a568 9917
cf4a9129
LC
9918In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
9919code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
9920code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
9921--source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
9922directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
9923@code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
8451a568 9924
cf4a9129
LC
9925@c XXX: keep me up-to-date
9926The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
9927@code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
9928opt-in---debugging information is available only for those packages
9929whose definition explicitly declares a @code{debug} output. This may be
9930changed to opt-out in the future, if our build farm servers can handle
9931the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
9932@command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
8451a568 9933
8451a568 9934
05962f29
LC
9935@node Security Updates
9936@section Security Updates
9937
843858b8
LC
9938@quotation Note
9939As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described in this section is
9940experimental.
9941@end quotation
05962f29
LC
9942
9943@cindex security updates
9944Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in core
9945software packages and must be patched. Guix follows a functional
9946package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
9947that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
9948must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
9949fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
9950distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
9951(@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
9952desired.
9953
9954@cindex grafts
9955To address that, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
9956for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
9957with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
9958package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
9959explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
9960the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
9961order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
9962
9963@cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
9964For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
9965Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
9966Bash, say @var{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
9967Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
9968@code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
9969
9970@example
9971(define bash
9972 (package
9973 (name "bash")
9974 ;; @dots{}
9975 (replacement bash-fixed)))
9976@end example
9977
9978From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash that
9979is installed will automatically be ``rewritten'' to refer to
9980@var{bash-fixed} instead of @var{bash}. This grafting process takes
9981time proportional to the size of the package, but expect less than a
9982minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine.
9983
9984Currently, the graft and the package it replaces (@var{bash-fixed} and
9985@var{bash} in the example above) must have the exact same @code{name}
9986and @code{version} fields. This restriction mostly comes from the fact
9987that grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
9988Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
9989package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
9990replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
9991
9992
cf4a9129
LC
9993@node Package Modules
9994@section Package Modules
8451a568 9995
cf4a9129
LC
9996From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
9997GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
9998@dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
9999packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
10000packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
10001naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
10002as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
10003define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
10004Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
10005module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
10006@code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
113daf62 10007
300868ba 10008The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
cf4a9129
LC
10009automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
10010instance, when running @code{guix package -i emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
10011packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
10012object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
10013facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
113daf62 10014
300868ba 10015@cindex customization, of packages
8689901f 10016@cindex package module search path
cf4a9129 10017Users can store package definitions in modules with different
60142854 10018names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
c95ded7e
LC
10019name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
10020emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
10021relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
10022@code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
10023guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. These package definitions
300868ba
LC
10024will not be visible by default. Thus, users can invoke commands such as
10025@command{guix package} and @command{guix build} have to be used with the
c95ded7e
LC
10026@code{-e} option so that they know where to find the package. Better
10027yet, they can use the
300868ba 10028@code{-L} option of these commands to make those modules visible
8689901f
LC
10029(@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--load-path}}), or define the
10030@code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} environment variable. This environment
10031variable makes it easy to extend or customize the distribution and is
10032honored by all the user interfaces.
10033
10034@defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
10035This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for package
10036modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence over the
10037distribution's own modules.
10038@end defvr
ef5dd60a 10039
cf4a9129
LC
10040The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
10041each package is built based solely on other packages in the
10042distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
10043@dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
10044bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
081145cf 10045@pxref{Bootstrapping}.
ef5dd60a 10046
cf4a9129
LC
10047@node Packaging Guidelines
10048@section Packaging Guidelines
ef5dd60a 10049
cf4a9129
LC
10050The GNU distribution is nascent and may well lack some of your favorite
10051packages. This section describes how you can help make the distribution
10052grow. @xref{Contributing}, for additional information on how you can
10053help.
ef5dd60a 10054
cf4a9129
LC
10055Free software packages are usually distributed in the form of
10056@dfn{source code tarballs}---typically @file{tar.gz} files that contain
10057all the source files. Adding a package to the distribution means
10058essentially two things: adding a @dfn{recipe} that describes how to
10059build the package, including a list of other packages required to build
10060it, and adding @dfn{package meta-data} along with that recipe, such as a
10061description and licensing information.
ef5dd60a 10062
cf4a9129
LC
10063In Guix all this information is embodied in @dfn{package definitions}.
10064Package definitions provide a high-level view of the package. They are
10065written using the syntax of the Scheme programming language; in fact,
10066for each package we define a variable bound to the package definition,
10067and export that variable from a module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10068However, in-depth Scheme knowledge is @emph{not} a prerequisite for
10069creating packages. For more information on package definitions,
081145cf 10070@pxref{Defining Packages}.
ef5dd60a 10071
cf4a9129
LC
10072Once a package definition is in place, stored in a file in the Guix
10073source tree, it can be tested using the @command{guix build} command
10074(@pxref{Invoking guix build}). For example, assuming the new package is
c71979f4
LC
10075called @code{gnew}, you may run this command from the Guix build tree
10076(@pxref{Running Guix Before It Is Installed}):
ef5dd60a
LC
10077
10078@example
cf4a9129 10079./pre-inst-env guix build gnew --keep-failed
ef5dd60a 10080@end example
ef5dd60a 10081
cf4a9129
LC
10082Using @code{--keep-failed} makes it easier to debug build failures since
10083it provides access to the failed build tree. Another useful
10084command-line option when debugging is @code{--log-file}, to access the
10085build log.
ef5dd60a 10086
cf4a9129
LC
10087If the package is unknown to the @command{guix} command, it may be that
10088the source file contains a syntax error, or lacks a @code{define-public}
10089clause to export the package variable. To figure it out, you may load
10090the module from Guile to get more information about the actual error:
ef5dd60a 10091
cf4a9129
LC
10092@example
10093./pre-inst-env guile -c '(use-modules (gnu packages gnew))'
10094@end example
ef5dd60a 10095
cf4a9129
LC
10096Once your package builds correctly, please send us a patch
10097(@pxref{Contributing}). Well, if you need help, we will be happy to
10098help you too. Once the patch is committed in the Guix repository, the
10099new package automatically gets built on the supported platforms by
2b1cee21 10100@url{http://hydra.gnu.org/jobset/gnu/master, our continuous integration
cf4a9129 10101system}.
ef5dd60a 10102
cf4a9129
LC
10103@cindex substituter
10104Users can obtain the new package definition simply by running
10105@command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). When
10106@code{hydra.gnu.org} is done building the package, installing the
10107package automatically downloads binaries from there
10108(@pxref{Substitutes}). The only place where human intervention is
10109needed is to review and apply the patch.
ef5dd60a 10110
ef5dd60a 10111
cf4a9129 10112@menu
ec0339cd
LC
10113* Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
10114* Package Naming:: What's in a name?
10115* Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
cbd02397 10116* Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
ec0339cd
LC
10117* Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
10118* Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
10119* Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
cf4a9129 10120@end menu
ef5dd60a 10121
cf4a9129
LC
10122@node Software Freedom
10123@subsection Software Freedom
ef5dd60a 10124
cf4a9129 10125@c Adapted from http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/philosophy.html.
c11a6eb1 10126
cf4a9129
LC
10127The GNU operating system has been developed so that users can have
10128freedom in their computing. GNU is @dfn{free software}, meaning that
10129users have the @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,four
10130essential freedoms}: to run the program, to study and change the program
10131in source code form, to redistribute exact copies, and to distribute
10132modified versions. Packages found in the GNU distribution provide only
10133software that conveys these four freedoms.
c11a6eb1 10134
cf4a9129
LC
10135In addition, the GNU distribution follow the
10136@url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-system-distribution-guidelines.html,free
10137software distribution guidelines}. Among other things, these guidelines
10138reject non-free firmware, recommendations of non-free software, and
10139discuss ways to deal with trademarks and patents.
ef5dd60a 10140
cf4a9129
LC
10141Some packages contain a small and optional subset that violates the
10142above guidelines, for instance because this subset is itself non-free
10143code. When that happens, the offending items are removed with
10144appropriate patches or code snippets in the package definition's
10145@code{origin} form (@pxref{Defining Packages}). That way, @code{guix
10146build --source} returns the ``freed'' source rather than the unmodified
10147upstream source.
ef5dd60a 10148
ef5dd60a 10149
cf4a9129
LC
10150@node Package Naming
10151@subsection Package Naming
ef5dd60a 10152
cf4a9129
LC
10153A package has actually two names associated with it:
10154First, there is the name of the @emph{Scheme variable}, the one following
10155@code{define-public}. By this name, the package can be made known in the
10156Scheme code, for instance as input to another package. Second, there is
10157the string in the @code{name} field of a package definition. This name
10158is used by package management commands such as
10159@command{guix package} and @command{guix build}.
ef5dd60a 10160
cf4a9129
LC
10161Both are usually the same and correspond to the lowercase conversion of
10162the project name chosen upstream, with underscores replaced with
10163hyphens. For instance, GNUnet is available as @code{gnunet}, and
10164SDL_net as @code{sdl-net}.
927097ef 10165
cf4a9129 10166We do not add @code{lib} prefixes for library packages, unless these are
081145cf 10167already part of the official project name. But @pxref{Python
cf4a9129
LC
10168Modules} and @ref{Perl Modules} for special rules concerning modules for
10169the Python and Perl languages.
927097ef 10170
1b366ee4 10171Font package names are handled differently, @pxref{Fonts}.
7fec52b7 10172
ef5dd60a 10173
cf4a9129
LC
10174@node Version Numbers
10175@subsection Version Numbers
ef5dd60a 10176
cf4a9129
LC
10177We usually package only the latest version of a given free software
10178project. But sometimes, for instance for incompatible library versions,
10179two (or more) versions of the same package are needed. These require
10180different Scheme variable names. We use the name as defined
10181in @ref{Package Naming}
10182for the most recent version; previous versions use the same name, suffixed
10183by @code{-} and the smallest prefix of the version number that may
10184distinguish the two versions.
ef5dd60a 10185
cf4a9129
LC
10186The name inside the package definition is the same for all versions of a
10187package and does not contain any version number.
ef5dd60a 10188
cf4a9129 10189For instance, the versions 2.24.20 and 3.9.12 of GTK+ may be packaged as follows:
ef5dd60a 10190
cf4a9129
LC
10191@example
10192(define-public gtk+
10193 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10194 (name "gtk+")
10195 (version "3.9.12")
10196 ...))
cf4a9129
LC
10197(define-public gtk+-2
10198 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10199 (name "gtk+")
10200 (version "2.24.20")
10201 ...))
cf4a9129
LC
10202@end example
10203If we also wanted GTK+ 3.8.2, this would be packaged as
10204@example
10205(define-public gtk+-3.8
10206 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10207 (name "gtk+")
10208 (version "3.8.2")
10209 ...))
cf4a9129 10210@end example
ef5dd60a 10211
880d647d
LC
10212@c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2016-01/msg00425.html>,
10213@c for a discussion of what follows.
10214@cindex version number, for VCS snapshots
10215Occasionally, we package snapshots of upstream's version control system
10216(VCS) instead of formal releases. This should remain exceptional,
10217because it is up to upstream developers to clarify what the stable
10218release is. Yet, it is sometimes necessary. So, what should we put in
10219the @code{version} field?
10220
10221Clearly, we need to make the commit identifier of the VCS snapshot
10222visible in the version string, but we also need to make sure that the
10223version string is monotonically increasing so that @command{guix package
10224--upgrade} can determine which version is newer. Since commit
10225identifiers, notably with Git, are not monotonically increasing, we add
10226a revision number that we increase each time we upgrade to a newer
10227snapshot. The resulting version string looks like this:
10228
10229@example
102302.0.11-3.cabba9e
10231 ^ ^ ^
10232 | | `-- upstream commit ID
10233 | |
10234 | `--- Guix package revision
10235 |
10236latest upstream version
10237@end example
10238
10239It is a good idea to strip commit identifiers in the @code{version}
10240field to, say, 7 digits. It avoids an aesthetic annoyance (assuming
10241aesthetics have a role to play here) as well as problems related to OS
10242limits such as the maximum shebang length (127 bytes for the Linux
10243kernel.) It is best to use the full commit identifiers in
10244@code{origin}s, though, to avoid ambiguities.
10245
cbd02397
LC
10246@node Synopses and Descriptions
10247@subsection Synopses and Descriptions
10248
10249As we have seen before, each package in GNU@tie{}Guix includes a
10250synopsis and a description (@pxref{Defining Packages}). Synopses and
10251descriptions are important: They are what @command{guix package
10252--search} searches, and a crucial piece of information to help users
10253determine whether a given package suits their needs. Consequently,
10254packagers should pay attention to what goes into them.
10255
10256Synopses must start with a capital letter and must not end with a
10257period. They must not start with ``a'' or ``the'', which usually does
10258not bring anything; for instance, prefer ``File-frobbing tool'' over ``A
10259tool that frobs files''. The synopsis should say what the package
10260is---e.g., ``Core GNU utilities (file, text, shell)''---or what it is
10261used for---e.g., the synopsis for GNU@tie{}grep is ``Print lines
10262matching a pattern''.
10263
10264Keep in mind that the synopsis must be meaningful for a very wide
10265audience. For example, ``Manipulate alignments in the SAM format''
10266might make sense for a seasoned bioinformatics researcher, but might be
10267fairly unhelpful or even misleading to a non-specialized audience. It
10268is a good idea to come up with a synopsis that gives an idea of the
10269application domain of the package. In this example, this might give
10270something like ``Manipulate nucleotide sequence alignments'', which
10271hopefully gives the user a better idea of whether this is what they are
10272looking for.
10273
10274@cindex Texinfo markup, in package descriptions
10275Descriptions should take between five and ten lines. Use full
10276sentences, and avoid using acronyms without first introducing them.
10277Descriptions can include Texinfo markup, which is useful to introduce
10278ornaments such as @code{@@code} or @code{@@dfn}, bullet lists, or
ba7d6c76
ML
10279hyperlinks (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). However you
10280should be careful when using some characters for example @samp{@@} and
10281curly braces which are the basic special characters in Texinfo
10282(@pxref{Special Characters,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). User interfaces
10283such as @command{guix package --show} take care of rendering it
10284appropriately.
cbd02397
LC
10285
10286Synopses and descriptions are translated by volunteers
10287@uref{http://translationproject.org/domain/guix-packages.html, at the
10288Translation Project} so that as many users as possible can read them in
10289their native language. User interfaces search them and display them in
10290the language specified by the current locale.
10291
10292Translation is a lot of work so, as a packager, please pay even more
10293attention to your synopses and descriptions as every change may entail
ba7d6c76 10294additional work for translators. In order to help them, it is possible
36743e71 10295to make recommendations or instructions visible to them by inserting
ba7d6c76
ML
10296special comments like this (@pxref{xgettext Invocation,,, gettext, GNU
10297Gettext}):
10298
10299@example
10300;; TRANSLATORS: "X11 resize-and-rotate" should not be translated.
10301(description "ARandR is designed to provide a simple visual front end
10302for the X11 resize-and-rotate (RandR) extension. @dots{}")
10303@end example
cbd02397 10304
ef5dd60a 10305
cf4a9129
LC
10306@node Python Modules
10307@subsection Python Modules
ef5dd60a 10308
cf4a9129
LC
10309We currently package Python 2 and Python 3, under the Scheme variable names
10310@code{python-2} and @code{python} as explained in @ref{Version Numbers}.
10311To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages, it
10312seems desirable that the name of a package for a Python module contains
10313the word @code{python}.
ef5dd60a 10314
cf4a9129
LC
10315Some modules are compatible with only one version of Python, others with both.
10316If the package Foo compiles only with Python 3, we name it
10317@code{python-foo}; if it compiles only with Python 2, we name it
10318@code{python2-foo}. If it is compatible with both versions, we create two
10319packages with the corresponding names.
ef5dd60a 10320
cf4a9129
LC
10321If a project already contains the word @code{python}, we drop this;
10322for instance, the module python-dateutil is packaged under the names
10323@code{python-dateutil} and @code{python2-dateutil}.
113daf62 10324
523e4896 10325
cf4a9129
LC
10326@node Perl Modules
10327@subsection Perl Modules
523e4896 10328
cf4a9129
LC
10329Perl programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
10330using the lowercase upstream name.
10331For Perl packages containing a single class, we use the lowercase class name,
10332replace all occurrences of @code{::} by dashes and prepend the prefix
10333@code{perl-}.
10334So the class @code{XML::Parser} becomes @code{perl-xml-parser}.
10335Modules containing several classes keep their lowercase upstream name and
10336are also prepended by @code{perl-}. Such modules tend to have the word
10337@code{perl} somewhere in their name, which gets dropped in favor of the
10338prefix. For instance, @code{libwww-perl} becomes @code{perl-libwww}.
523e4896 10339
523e4896 10340
7fec52b7
AE
10341@node Fonts
10342@subsection Fonts
10343
10344For fonts that are in general not installed by a user for typesetting
10345purposes, or that are distributed as part of a larger software package,
10346we rely on the general packaging rules for software; for instance, this
10347applies to the fonts delivered as part of the X.Org system or fonts that
10348are part of TeX Live.
10349
10350To make it easier for a user to search for fonts, names for other packages
10351containing only fonts are constructed as follows, independently of the
10352upstream package name.
10353
10354The name of a package containing only one font family starts with
10355@code{font-}; it is followed by the foundry name and a dash @code{-}
10356if the foundry is known, and the font family name, in which spaces are
10357replaced by dashes (and as usual, all upper case letters are transformed
10358to lower case).
10359For example, the Gentium font family by SIL is packaged under the name
10360@code{font-sil-gentium}.
10361
10362For a package containing several font families, the name of the collection
10363is used in the place of the font family name.
10364For instance, the Liberation fonts consist of three families,
10365Liberation Sans, Liberation Serif and Liberation Mono.
10366These could be packaged separately under the names
10367@code{font-liberation-sans} and so on; but as they are distributed together
10368under a common name, we prefer to package them together as
10369@code{font-liberation}.
10370
10371In the case where several formats of the same font family or font collection
10372are packaged separately, a short form of the format, prepended by a dash,
10373is added to the package name. We use @code{-ttf} for TrueType fonts,
1b366ee4 10374@code{-otf} for OpenType fonts and @code{-type1} for PostScript Type 1
7fec52b7
AE
10375fonts.
10376
10377
b25937e3 10378
cf4a9129
LC
10379@node Bootstrapping
10380@section Bootstrapping
b25937e3 10381
cf4a9129 10382@c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
b25937e3 10383
cf4a9129 10384@cindex bootstrapping
7889394e 10385
cf4a9129
LC
10386Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
10387``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
10388contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
10389there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
10390get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
10391a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
10392user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
10393a ``regular user''.
72b9d60d 10394
cf4a9129
LC
10395@cindex bootstrap binaries
10396The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
10397GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
10398command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
10399`grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
10400@code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
10401(@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
10402all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
10403Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
10404@dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
72b9d60d 10405
cf4a9129
LC
10406These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
10407re-create them if needed (more on that later).
72b9d60d 10408
cf4a9129 10409@unnumberedsubsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
c79d54fe 10410
cf4a9129
LC
10411@c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
10412@c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
10413@image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
523e4896 10414
cf4a9129
LC
10415The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
10416distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
d33fa0c7
LC
10417packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
10418@command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
10419
10420@example
10421guix graph -t derivation \
10422 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
10423 | dot -Tps > t.ps
10424@end example
10425
10426At this level of detail, things are
cf4a9129
LC
10427slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
10428along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
10429loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
10430tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
10431distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
10432(@pxref{The Store}).
2e7b5cea 10433
cf4a9129
LC
10434But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
10435to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
10436derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
10437builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
10438@code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
10439@file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
10440the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
10441tarball to be unpacked.
fb729425 10442
cf4a9129
LC
10443Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
10444Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
10445is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
10446is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
10447@code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
10448@code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
10449in the store, using the original layout. The
10450@code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
10451write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
10452corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
10453@code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
fb729425 10454
cf4a9129
LC
10455Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
10456derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
10457etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
fb729425 10458
fb729425 10459
cf4a9129 10460@unnumberedsubsec Building the Build Tools
523e4896 10461
cf4a9129
LC
10462Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
10463depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
10464no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
10465the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
10466directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
10467``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
1f6f57df 10468the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
df2ce343 10469
d33fa0c7
LC
10470The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
10471the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
10472individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
10473several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
10474one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
10475package from source. The command:
10476
10477@example
10478guix graph -t bag \
10479 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
10480 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
10481@end example
10482
10483@noindent
10484produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
10485library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
10486suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
10487approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
10488
10489@image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
10490
cf4a9129
LC
10491@c See <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
10492The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
d33fa0c7
LC
10493GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
10494for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
10495built.
523e4896 10496
cf4a9129
LC
10497Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
10498tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
10499used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
10500guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
4af2447e 10501
d33fa0c7
LC
10502From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
10503GCC uses @code{ld}
cf4a9129
LC
10504from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
10505This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
10506the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
4af2447e 10507
cf4a9129
LC
10508And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
10509the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
dd164244
MW
10510variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
10511implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
1f6f57df 10512(@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
4af2447e 10513
4af2447e 10514
cf4a9129 10515@unnumberedsubsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
4af2447e 10516
cf4a9129
LC
10517Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
10518those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
10519automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
10520the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
4af2447e 10521
cf4a9129
LC
10522The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
10523binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
10524of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
4b2615e1 10525
cf4a9129
LC
10526@example
10527guix build bootstrap-tarballs
10528@end example
10529
10530The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
10531@code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
10532this section.
10533
10534Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
10535reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
10536unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
10537significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
10538know.
10539
10540@node Porting
10541@section Porting to a New Platform
10542
10543As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
10544self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
10545binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
10546operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
10547interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
10548not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
10549the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
10550
10551Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
10552When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
10553target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
10554one:
10555
10556@example
10557guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
10558@end example
10559
1c0c417d
LC
10560For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
10561@code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
10562file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
10563@code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
10564taught about the new platform.
10565
cf4a9129 10566Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
1c0c417d
LC
10567to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
10568is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
10569must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
10570bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
10571available locally, and @file{gnu-system.am} has rules do download it for
10572the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
10573as well.
cf4a9129
LC
10574
10575In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
10576extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
10577above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
10578recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
10579configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
10580Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
10581platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
10582reason.
4af2447e 10583
9bf3c1a7 10584@c *********************************************************************
8c01b9d0 10585@include contributing.texi
c78bd12b 10586
568717fd
LC
10587@c *********************************************************************
10588@node Acknowledgments
10589@chapter Acknowledgments
10590
136787cb
LC
10591Guix is based on the @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
10592which was designed and
4c7ac9aa
LC
10593implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
10594the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
568717fd
LC
10595management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
10596package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
10597transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
10598
10599The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
10600an inspiration for Guix.
10601
4c7ac9aa
LC
10602GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
10603number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
10604information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
10605who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
10606providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
10607
10608
568717fd
LC
10609@c *********************************************************************
10610@node GNU Free Documentation License
10611@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
10612
10613@include fdl-1.3.texi
10614
10615@c *********************************************************************
10616@node Concept Index
10617@unnumbered Concept Index
10618@printindex cp
10619
a85b83d2
LC
10620@node Programming Index
10621@unnumbered Programming Index
10622@syncodeindex tp fn
10623@syncodeindex vr fn
568717fd
LC
10624@printindex fn
10625
10626@bye
10627
10628@c Local Variables:
10629@c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
10630@c End: